diff options
-rw-r--r-- | libX11/src/XlibInt.c | 4342 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/glsl/Makefile | 2 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/glsl/ast_to_hir.cpp | 31 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/glsl/glsl_symbol_table.cpp | 337 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/glsl/ir.cpp | 2 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/mesa/Makefile | 2 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/mesa/main/extensions.c | 494 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/mesa/main/mtypes.h | 2 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/mesa/main/texobj.c | 32 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/mesa/program/program.c | 4 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_atom_pixeltransfer.c | 2 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_cb_drawpixels.c | 4 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_program.c | 2 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/hw/xfree86/man/xorg.conf.man | 4963 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/include/xkbsrv.h | 5 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/xkb/XKBAlloc.c | 19 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/xkb/ddxLoad.c | 22 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/xkb/xkb.c | 34 |
18 files changed, 5209 insertions, 5090 deletions
diff --git a/libX11/src/XlibInt.c b/libX11/src/XlibInt.c index b5ed3fc8d..305670214 100644 --- a/libX11/src/XlibInt.c +++ b/libX11/src/XlibInt.c @@ -1,2165 +1,2177 @@ -/* - -Copyright 1985, 1986, 1987, 1998 The Open Group - -Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software and its -documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided that -the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that -copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting -documentation. - -The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included -in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - -THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS -OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF -MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. -IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OPEN GROUP BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR -OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, -ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR -OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - -Except as contained in this notice, the name of The Open Group shall -not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or -other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization -from The Open Group. - -*/ - -/* - * XlibInt.c - Internal support routines for the C subroutine - * interface library (Xlib) to the X Window System Protocol V11.0. - */ - -#ifdef WIN32 -#define _XLIBINT_ -#include <X11\Xw32defs.h> -#endif -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -#include <config.h> -#endif -#include "Xlibint.h" -#include "Xprivate.h" -#include <X11/Xpoll.h> -#include <assert.h> -#include <stdio.h> -#ifdef WIN32 -#include <direct.h> -#endif - -#ifdef XTHREADS -#include "locking.h" - -/* these pointers get initialized by XInitThreads */ -LockInfoPtr _Xglobal_lock = NULL; -void (*_XCreateMutex_fn)(LockInfoPtr) = NULL; -/* struct _XCVList *(*_XCreateCVL_fn)() = NULL; */ -void (*_XFreeMutex_fn)(LockInfoPtr) = NULL; -void (*_XLockMutex_fn)( - LockInfoPtr /* lock */ -#if defined(XTHREADS_WARN) || defined(XTHREADS_FILE_LINE) - , char * /* file */ - , int /* line */ -#endif - ) = NULL; -void (*_XUnlockMutex_fn)( - LockInfoPtr /* lock */ -#if defined(XTHREADS_WARN) || defined(XTHREADS_FILE_LINE) - , char * /* file */ - , int /* line */ -#endif - ) = NULL; -xthread_t (*_Xthread_self_fn)(void) = NULL; - -#define XThread_Self() ((*_Xthread_self_fn)()) - -#endif /* XTHREADS */ - -/* check for both EAGAIN and EWOULDBLOCK, because some supposedly POSIX - * systems are broken and return EWOULDBLOCK when they should return EAGAIN - */ -#ifdef WIN32 -#define ETEST() (WSAGetLastError() == WSAEWOULDBLOCK) -#else -#ifdef __CYGWIN__ /* Cygwin uses ENOBUFS to signal socket is full */ -#define ETEST() (errno == EAGAIN || errno == EWOULDBLOCK || errno == ENOBUFS) -#else -#if defined(EAGAIN) && defined(EWOULDBLOCK) -#define ETEST() (errno == EAGAIN || errno == EWOULDBLOCK) -#else -#ifdef EAGAIN -#define ETEST() (errno == EAGAIN) -#else -#define ETEST() (errno == EWOULDBLOCK) -#endif /* EAGAIN */ -#endif /* EAGAIN && EWOULDBLOCK */ -#endif /* __CYGWIN__ */ -#endif /* WIN32 */ - -#ifdef WIN32 -#define ECHECK(err) (WSAGetLastError() == err) -#define ESET(val) WSASetLastError(val) -#else -#ifdef __UNIXOS2__ -#define ECHECK(err) (errno == err) -#define ESET(val) -#else -#define ECHECK(err) (errno == err) -#define ESET(val) errno = val -#endif -#endif - -#if defined(LOCALCONN) || defined(LACHMAN) -#ifdef EMSGSIZE -#define ESZTEST() (ECHECK(EMSGSIZE) || ECHECK(ERANGE)) -#else -#define ESZTEST() ECHECK(ERANGE) -#endif -#else -#ifdef EMSGSIZE -#define ESZTEST() ECHECK(EMSGSIZE) -#endif -#endif - -#ifdef __UNIXOS2__ -#include <limits.h> -#define MAX_PATH _POSIX_PATH_MAX -#endif - -/* - * The following routines are internal routines used by Xlib for protocol - * packet transmission and reception. - * - * _XIOError(Display *) will be called if any sort of system call error occurs. - * This is assumed to be a fatal condition, i.e., XIOError should not return. - * - * _XError(Display *, xError *) will be called whenever an X_Error event is - * received. This is not assumed to be a fatal condition, i.e., it is - * acceptable for this procedure to return. However, XError should NOT - * perform any operations (directly or indirectly) on the DISPLAY. - * - * Routines declared with a return type of 'Status' return 0 on failure, - * and non 0 on success. Routines with no declared return type don't - * return anything. Whenever possible routines that create objects return - * the object they have created. - */ - -#define POLLFD_CACHE_SIZE 5 - -#if _WIN32_WINNT < _WIN32_WINNT_VISTA -struct pollfd { - - SOCKET fd; - SHORT events; - SHORT revents; - -}; -#define POLLRDNORM 0x0100 -#define POLLRDBAND 0x0200 -#define POLLIN (POLLRDNORM | POLLRDBAND) -#endif - -/* initialize the struct array passed to poll() below */ -Bool _XPollfdCacheInit( - Display *dpy) -{ -#ifdef USE_POLL - struct pollfd *pfp; - - pfp = (struct pollfd *)Xmalloc(POLLFD_CACHE_SIZE * sizeof(struct pollfd)); - if (!pfp) - return False; - pfp[0].fd = dpy->fd; - pfp[0].events = POLLIN; - - dpy->filedes = (XPointer)pfp; -#endif - return True; -} - -void _XPollfdCacheAdd( - Display *dpy, - int fd) -{ -#ifdef USE_POLL - struct pollfd *pfp = (struct pollfd *)dpy->filedes; - - if (dpy->im_fd_length <= POLLFD_CACHE_SIZE) { - pfp[dpy->im_fd_length].fd = fd; - pfp[dpy->im_fd_length].events = POLLIN; - } -#endif -} - -/* ARGSUSED */ -void _XPollfdCacheDel( - Display *dpy, - int fd) /* not used */ -{ -#ifdef USE_POLL - struct pollfd *pfp = (struct pollfd *)dpy->filedes; - struct _XConnectionInfo *conni; - - /* just recalculate whole list */ - if (dpy->im_fd_length <= POLLFD_CACHE_SIZE) { - int loc = 1; - for (conni = dpy->im_fd_info; conni; conni=conni->next) { - pfp[loc].fd = conni->fd; - pfp[loc].events = POLLIN; - loc++; - } - } -#endif -} - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#undef min -#define min __min -#endif - -static int sync_hazard(Display *dpy) -{ - unsigned long span = dpy->request - dpy->last_request_read; - unsigned long hazard = min((dpy->bufmax - dpy->buffer) / SIZEOF(xReq), 65535 - 10); - return span >= 65535 - hazard - 10; -} - -static -void sync_while_locked(Display *dpy) -{ -#ifdef XTHREADS - if (dpy->lock) - (*dpy->lock->user_lock_display)(dpy); -#endif - UnlockDisplay(dpy); - SyncHandle(); - InternalLockDisplay(dpy, /* don't skip user locks */ 0); -#ifdef XTHREADS - if (dpy->lock) - (*dpy->lock->user_unlock_display)(dpy); -#endif -} - -void _XSeqSyncFunction( - register Display *dpy) -{ - xGetInputFocusReply rep; - register xReq *req; - - if ((dpy->request - dpy->last_request_read) >= (65535 - BUFSIZE/SIZEOF(xReq))) { - GetEmptyReq(GetInputFocus, req); - (void) _XReply (dpy, (xReply *)&rep, 0, xTrue); - sync_while_locked(dpy); - } else if (sync_hazard(dpy)) - _XSetPrivSyncFunction(dpy); -} - -/* NOTE: only called if !XTHREADS, or when XInitThreads wasn't called. */ -static int -_XPrivSyncFunction (Display *dpy) -{ -#ifdef XTHREADS - assert(!dpy->lock_fns); -#endif - assert(dpy->synchandler == _XPrivSyncFunction); - assert((dpy->flags & XlibDisplayPrivSync) != 0); - dpy->synchandler = dpy->savedsynchandler; - dpy->savedsynchandler = NULL; - dpy->flags &= ~XlibDisplayPrivSync; - if(dpy->synchandler) - dpy->synchandler(dpy); - _XIDHandler(dpy); - _XSeqSyncFunction(dpy); - return 0; -} - -void _XSetPrivSyncFunction(Display *dpy) -{ -#ifdef XTHREADS - if (dpy->lock_fns) - return; -#endif - if (!(dpy->flags & XlibDisplayPrivSync)) { - dpy->savedsynchandler = dpy->synchandler; - dpy->synchandler = _XPrivSyncFunction; - dpy->flags |= XlibDisplayPrivSync; - } -} - -void _XSetSeqSyncFunction(Display *dpy) -{ - if (sync_hazard(dpy)) - _XSetPrivSyncFunction (dpy); -} - -#ifdef LONG64 -void _XRead32( - Display *dpy, - register long *data, - long len) -{ - register int *buf; - register long i; - - if (len) { - (void) _XRead(dpy, (char *)data, len); - i = len >> 2; - buf = (int *)data + i; - data += i; - while (--i >= 0) - *--data = *--buf; - } -} -#endif /* LONG64 */ - -#ifdef WORD64 - -/* - * XXX This is a *really* stupid way of doing this.... - * PACKBUFFERSIZE must be a multiple of 4. - */ - -#define PACKBUFFERSIZE 4096 - - -/* - * _XRead32 - Read bytes from the socket unpacking each 32 bits - * into a long (64 bits on a CRAY computer). - * - */ -static void _doXRead32( - register Display *dpy, - register long *data - register long size, - register char *packbuffer) -{ - long *lpack,*lp; - long mask32 = 0x00000000ffffffff; - long maskw, nwords, i, bits; - - _XReadPad (dpy, packbuffer, size); - - lp = data; - lpack = (long *) packbuffer; - nwords = size >> 2; - bits = 32; - - for(i=0;i<nwords;i++){ - maskw = mask32 << bits; - *lp++ = ( *lpack & maskw ) >> bits; - bits = bits ^32; - if(bits){ - lpack++; - } - } -} - -void _XRead32( - Display *dpy, - long *data, - long len) -{ - char packbuffer[PACKBUFFERSIZE]; - unsigned nunits = PACKBUFFERSIZE >> 2; - - for (; len > PACKBUFFERSIZE; len -= PACKBUFFERSIZE, data += nunits) { - _doXRead32 (dpy, data, PACKBUFFERSIZE, packbuffer); - } - if (len) _doXRead32 (dpy, data, len, packbuffer); -} - - - -/* - * _XRead16 - Read bytes from the socket unpacking each 16 bits - * into a long (64 bits on a CRAY computer). - * - */ -static _doXRead16( - register Display *dpy, - register short *data, - register long size, - char *packbuffer) -{ - long *lpack,*lp; - long mask16 = 0x000000000000ffff; - long maskw, nwords, i, bits; - - (void) _XRead(dpy,packbuffer,size); /* don't do a padded read... */ - - lp = (long *) data; - lpack = (long *) packbuffer; - nwords = size >> 1; /* number of 16 bit words to be unpacked */ - bits = 48; - for(i=0;i<nwords;i++){ - maskw = mask16 << bits; - *lp++ = ( *lpack & maskw ) >> bits; - bits -= 16; - if(bits < 0){ - lpack++; - bits = 48; - } - } -} - -void _XRead16( - Display *dpy, - short *data, - long len) -{ - char packbuffer[PACKBUFFERSIZE]; - unsigned nunits = PACKBUFFERSIZE >> 1; - - for (; len > PACKBUFFERSIZE; len -= PACKBUFFERSIZE, data += nunits) { - _doXRead16 (dpy, data, PACKBUFFERSIZE, packbuffer); - } - if (len) _doXRead16 (dpy, data, len, packbuffer); -} - -void _XRead16Pad( - Display *dpy, - short *data, - long size) -{ - int slop = (size & 3); - short slopbuf[3]; - - _XRead16 (dpy, data, size); - if (slop > 0) { - _XRead16 (dpy, slopbuf, 4 - slop); - } -} -#endif /* WORD64 */ - -/* - * The hard part about this is that we only get 16 bits from a reply. - * We have three values that will march along, with the following invariant: - * dpy->last_request_read <= rep->sequenceNumber <= dpy->request - * We have to keep - * dpy->request - dpy->last_request_read < 2^16 - * or else we won't know for sure what value to use in events. We do this - * by forcing syncs when we get close. - */ - -unsigned long -_XSetLastRequestRead( - register Display *dpy, - register xGenericReply *rep) -{ - register unsigned long newseq, lastseq; - - lastseq = dpy->last_request_read; - /* - * KeymapNotify has no sequence number, but is always guaranteed - * to immediately follow another event, except when generated via - * SendEvent (hmmm). - */ - if ((rep->type & 0x7f) == KeymapNotify) - return(lastseq); - - newseq = (lastseq & ~((unsigned long)0xffff)) | rep->sequenceNumber; - - if (newseq < lastseq) { - newseq += 0x10000; - if (newseq > dpy->request) { - (void) fprintf (stderr, - "Xlib: sequence lost (0x%lx > 0x%lx) in reply type 0x%x!\n", - newseq, dpy->request, - (unsigned int) rep->type); - newseq -= 0x10000; - } - } - - dpy->last_request_read = newseq; - return(newseq); -} - -/* - * Support for internal connections, such as an IM might use. - * By Stephen Gildea, X Consortium, September 1993 - */ - -/* _XRegisterInternalConnection - * Each IM (or Xlib extension) that opens a file descriptor that Xlib should - * include in its select/poll mask must call this function to register the - * fd with Xlib. Any XConnectionWatchProc registered by XAddConnectionWatch - * will also be called. - * - * Whenever Xlib detects input available on fd, it will call callback - * with call_data to process it. If non-Xlib code calls select/poll - * and detects input available, it must call XProcessInternalConnection, - * which will call the associated callback. - * - * Non-Xlib code can learn about these additional fds by calling - * XInternalConnectionNumbers or, more typically, by registering - * a XConnectionWatchProc with XAddConnectionWatch - * to be called when fds are registered or unregistered. - * - * Returns True if registration succeeded, False if not, typically - * because could not allocate memory. - * Assumes Display locked when called. - */ -Status -_XRegisterInternalConnection( - Display* dpy, - int fd, - _XInternalConnectionProc callback, - XPointer call_data -) -{ - struct _XConnectionInfo *new_conni, **iptr; - struct _XConnWatchInfo *watchers; - XPointer *wd; - - new_conni = (struct _XConnectionInfo*)Xmalloc(sizeof(struct _XConnectionInfo)); - if (!new_conni) - return 0; - new_conni->watch_data = (XPointer *)Xmalloc(dpy->watcher_count * sizeof(XPointer)); - if (!new_conni->watch_data) { - Xfree(new_conni); - return 0; - } - new_conni->fd = fd; - new_conni->read_callback = callback; - new_conni->call_data = call_data; - new_conni->next = NULL; - /* link new structure onto end of list */ - for (iptr = &dpy->im_fd_info; *iptr; iptr = &(*iptr)->next) - ; - *iptr = new_conni; - dpy->im_fd_length++; - _XPollfdCacheAdd(dpy, fd); - - for (watchers=dpy->conn_watchers, wd=new_conni->watch_data; - watchers; - watchers=watchers->next, wd++) { - *wd = NULL; /* for cleanliness */ - (*watchers->fn) (dpy, watchers->client_data, fd, True, wd); - } - - return 1; -} - -/* _XUnregisterInternalConnection - * Each IM (or Xlib extension) that closes a file descriptor previously - * registered with _XRegisterInternalConnection must call this function. - * Any XConnectionWatchProc registered by XAddConnectionWatch - * will also be called. - * - * Assumes Display locked when called. - */ -void -_XUnregisterInternalConnection( - Display* dpy, - int fd -) -{ - struct _XConnectionInfo *info_list, **prev; - struct _XConnWatchInfo *watch; - XPointer *wd; - - for (prev = &dpy->im_fd_info; (info_list = *prev); - prev = &info_list->next) { - if (info_list->fd == fd) { - *prev = info_list->next; - dpy->im_fd_length--; - for (watch=dpy->conn_watchers, wd=info_list->watch_data; - watch; - watch=watch->next, wd++) { - (*watch->fn) (dpy, watch->client_data, fd, False, wd); - } - if (info_list->watch_data) - Xfree (info_list->watch_data); - Xfree (info_list); - break; - } - } - _XPollfdCacheDel(dpy, fd); -} - -/* XInternalConnectionNumbers - * Returns an array of fds and an array of corresponding call data. - * Typically a XConnectionWatchProc registered with XAddConnectionWatch - * will be used instead of this function to discover - * additional fds to include in the select/poll mask. - * - * The list is allocated with Xmalloc and should be freed by the caller - * with Xfree; - */ -Status -XInternalConnectionNumbers( - Display *dpy, - int **fd_return, - int *count_return -) -{ - int count; - struct _XConnectionInfo *info_list; - int *fd_list; - - LockDisplay(dpy); - count = 0; - for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) - count++; - fd_list = (int*) Xmalloc (count * sizeof(int)); - if (!fd_list) { - UnlockDisplay(dpy); - return 0; - } - count = 0; - for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) { - fd_list[count] = info_list->fd; - count++; - } - UnlockDisplay(dpy); - - *fd_return = fd_list; - *count_return = count; - return 1; -} - -void _XProcessInternalConnection( - Display *dpy, - struct _XConnectionInfo *conn_info) -{ - dpy->flags |= XlibDisplayProcConni; - UnlockDisplay(dpy); - (*conn_info->read_callback) (dpy, conn_info->fd, conn_info->call_data); - LockDisplay(dpy); - dpy->flags &= ~XlibDisplayProcConni; -} - -/* XProcessInternalConnection - * Call the _XInternalConnectionProc registered by _XRegisterInternalConnection - * for this fd. - * The Display is NOT locked during the call. - */ -void -XProcessInternalConnection( - Display* dpy, - int fd -) -{ - struct _XConnectionInfo *info_list; - - LockDisplay(dpy); - for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) { - if (info_list->fd == fd) { - _XProcessInternalConnection(dpy, info_list); - break; - } - } - UnlockDisplay(dpy); -} - -/* XAddConnectionWatch - * Register a callback to be called whenever _XRegisterInternalConnection - * or _XUnregisterInternalConnection is called. - * Callbacks are called with the Display locked. - * If any connections are already registered, the callback is immediately - * called for each of them. - */ -Status -XAddConnectionWatch( - Display* dpy, - XConnectionWatchProc callback, - XPointer client_data -) -{ - struct _XConnWatchInfo *new_watcher, **wptr; - struct _XConnectionInfo *info_list; - XPointer *wd_array; - - LockDisplay(dpy); - - /* allocate new watch data */ - for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) { - wd_array = (XPointer *)Xrealloc((char *)info_list->watch_data, - (dpy->watcher_count + 1) * - sizeof(XPointer)); - if (!wd_array) { - UnlockDisplay(dpy); - return 0; - } - info_list->watch_data = wd_array; - wd_array[dpy->watcher_count] = NULL; /* for cleanliness */ - } - - new_watcher = (struct _XConnWatchInfo*)Xmalloc(sizeof(struct _XConnWatchInfo)); - if (!new_watcher) { - UnlockDisplay(dpy); - return 0; - } - new_watcher->fn = callback; - new_watcher->client_data = client_data; - new_watcher->next = NULL; - - /* link new structure onto end of list */ - for (wptr = &dpy->conn_watchers; *wptr; wptr = &(*wptr)->next) - ; - *wptr = new_watcher; - dpy->watcher_count++; - - /* call new watcher on all currently registered fds */ - for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) { - (*callback) (dpy, client_data, info_list->fd, True, - info_list->watch_data + dpy->watcher_count - 1); - } - - UnlockDisplay(dpy); - return 1; -} - -/* XRemoveConnectionWatch - * Unregister a callback registered by XAddConnectionWatch. - * Both callback and client_data must match what was passed to - * XAddConnectionWatch. - */ -void -XRemoveConnectionWatch( - Display* dpy, - XConnectionWatchProc callback, - XPointer client_data -) -{ - struct _XConnWatchInfo *watch; - struct _XConnWatchInfo *previous = NULL; - struct _XConnectionInfo *conni; - int counter = 0; - - LockDisplay(dpy); - for (watch=dpy->conn_watchers; watch; watch=watch->next) { - if (watch->fn == callback && watch->client_data == client_data) { - if (previous) - previous->next = watch->next; - else - dpy->conn_watchers = watch->next; - Xfree (watch); - dpy->watcher_count--; - /* remove our watch_data for each connection */ - for (conni=dpy->im_fd_info; conni; conni=conni->next) { - /* don't bother realloc'ing; these arrays are small anyway */ - /* overlapping */ - memmove(conni->watch_data+counter, - conni->watch_data+counter+1, - dpy->watcher_count - counter); - } - break; - } - previous = watch; - counter++; - } - UnlockDisplay(dpy); -} - -/* end of internal connections support */ - -/* Cookie jar implementation - dpy->cookiejar is a linked list. _XEnq receives the events but leaves - them in the normal EQ. _XStoreEvent returns the cookie event (minus - data pointer) and adds it to the cookiejar. _XDeq just removes - the entry like any other event but resets the data pointer for - cookie events (to avoid double-free, the memory is re-used by Xlib). - - _XFetchEventCookie (called from XGetEventData) removes a cookie from the - jar. _XFreeEventCookies removes all unclaimed cookies from the jar - (called by XNextEvent). - - _XFreeDisplayStructure calls _XFreeEventCookies for each cookie in the - normal EQ. - */ - -#include "utlist.h" -struct stored_event { - XGenericEventCookie ev; - struct stored_event *prev; - struct stored_event *next; -}; - -Bool -_XIsEventCookie(Display *dpy, XEvent *ev) -{ - return (ev->xcookie.type == GenericEvent && - dpy->generic_event_vec[ev->xcookie.extension & 0x7F] != NULL); -} - -/** - * Free all events in the event list. - */ -void -_XFreeEventCookies(Display *dpy) -{ - struct stored_event **head, *e, *tmp; - - if (!dpy->cookiejar) - return; - - head = (struct stored_event**)&dpy->cookiejar; - - DL_FOREACH_SAFE(*head, e, tmp) { - if (dpy->cookiejar == e) - dpy->cookiejar = NULL; - XFree(e->ev.data); - XFree(e); - } -} - -/** - * Add an event to the display's event list. This event must be freed on the - * next call to XNextEvent(). - */ -void -_XStoreEventCookie(Display *dpy, XEvent *event) -{ - XGenericEventCookie* cookie = &event->xcookie; - struct stored_event **head, *add; - - if (!_XIsEventCookie(dpy, event)) - return; - - head = (struct stored_event**)(&dpy->cookiejar); - - add = Xmalloc(sizeof(struct stored_event)); - if (!add) { - ESET(ENOMEM); - _XIOError(dpy); - } - add->ev = *cookie; - DL_APPEND(*head, add); - cookie->data = NULL; /* don't return data yet, must be claimed */ -} - -/** - * Return the event with the given cookie and remove it from the list. - */ -Bool -_XFetchEventCookie(Display *dpy, XGenericEventCookie* ev) -{ - Bool ret = False; - struct stored_event **head, *event; - head = (struct stored_event**)&dpy->cookiejar; - - if (!_XIsEventCookie(dpy, (XEvent*)ev)) - return ret; - - DL_FOREACH(*head, event) { - if (event->ev.cookie == ev->cookie && - event->ev.extension == ev->extension && - event->ev.evtype == ev->evtype) { - *ev = event->ev; - DL_DELETE(*head, event); - Xfree(event); - ret = True; - break; - } - } - - return ret; -} - -Bool -_XCopyEventCookie(Display *dpy, XGenericEventCookie *in, XGenericEventCookie *out) -{ - Bool ret = False; - int extension; - - if (!_XIsEventCookie(dpy, (XEvent*)in) || !out) - return ret; - - extension = in->extension & 0x7F; - - if (!dpy->generic_event_copy_vec[extension]) - return ret; - - ret = ((*dpy->generic_event_copy_vec[extension])(dpy, in, out)); - out->cookie = ret ? ++dpy->next_cookie : 0; - return ret; -} - - -/* - * _XEnq - Place event packets on the display's queue. - * note that no squishing of move events in V11, since there - * is pointer motion hints.... - */ -void _XEnq( - register Display *dpy, - register xEvent *event) -{ - register _XQEvent *qelt; - int type, extension; - - if ((qelt = dpy->qfree)) { - /* If dpy->qfree is non-NULL do this, else malloc a new one. */ - dpy->qfree = qelt->next; - } - else if ((qelt = - (_XQEvent *) Xmalloc((unsigned)sizeof(_XQEvent))) == NULL) { - /* Malloc call failed! */ - ESET(ENOMEM); - _XIOError(dpy); - } - qelt->next = NULL; - - type = event->u.u.type & 0177; - extension = ((xGenericEvent*)event)->extension; - - qelt->event.type = type; - /* If an extension has registerd a generic_event_vec handler, then - * it can handle event cookies. Otherwise, proceed with the normal - * event handlers. - * - * If the generic_event_vec is called, qelt->event is a event cookie - * with the data pointer and the "free" pointer set. Data pointer is - * some memory allocated by the extension. - */ - if (type == GenericEvent && dpy->generic_event_vec[extension & 0x7F]) { - XGenericEventCookie *cookie = &qelt->event.xcookie; - (*dpy->generic_event_vec[extension & 0x7F])(dpy, cookie, event); - cookie->cookie = ++dpy->next_cookie; - - qelt->qserial_num = dpy->next_event_serial_num++; - if (dpy->tail) dpy->tail->next = qelt; - else dpy->head = qelt; - - dpy->tail = qelt; - dpy->qlen++; - } else if ((*dpy->event_vec[type])(dpy, &qelt->event, event)) { - qelt->qserial_num = dpy->next_event_serial_num++; - if (dpy->tail) dpy->tail->next = qelt; - else dpy->head = qelt; - - dpy->tail = qelt; - dpy->qlen++; - } else { - /* ignored, or stashed away for many-to-one compression */ - qelt->next = dpy->qfree; - dpy->qfree = qelt; - } -} - -/* - * _XDeq - Remove event packet from the display's queue. - */ -void _XDeq( - register Display *dpy, - register _XQEvent *prev, /* element before qelt */ - register _XQEvent *qelt) /* element to be unlinked */ -{ - if (prev) { - if ((prev->next = qelt->next) == NULL) - dpy->tail = prev; - } else { - /* no prev, so removing first elt */ - if ((dpy->head = qelt->next) == NULL) - dpy->tail = NULL; - } - qelt->qserial_num = 0; - qelt->next = dpy->qfree; - dpy->qfree = qelt; - dpy->qlen--; - - if (_XIsEventCookie(dpy, &qelt->event)) { - XGenericEventCookie* cookie = &qelt->event.xcookie; - /* dpy->qfree is re-used, reset memory to avoid double free on - * _XFreeDisplayStructure */ - cookie->data = NULL; - } -} - -/* - * EventToWire in separate file in that often not needed. - */ - -/*ARGSUSED*/ -Bool -_XUnknownWireEvent( - register Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */ - register XEvent *re, /* pointer to where event should be reformatted */ - register xEvent *event) /* wire protocol event */ -{ -#ifdef notdef - (void) fprintf(stderr, - "Xlib: unhandled wire event! event number = %d, display = %x\n.", - event->u.u.type, dpy); -#endif - return(False); -} - -Bool -_XUnknownWireEventCookie( - Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */ - XGenericEventCookie *re, /* pointer to where event should be reformatted */ - xEvent *event) /* wire protocol event */ -{ -#ifdef notdef - fprintf(stderr, - "Xlib: unhandled wire cookie event! extension number = %d, display = %x\n.", - ((xGenericEvent*)event)->extension, dpy); -#endif - return(False); -} - -Bool -_XUnknownCopyEventCookie( - Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */ - XGenericEventCookie *in, /* source */ - XGenericEventCookie *out) /* destination */ -{ -#ifdef notdef - fprintf(stderr, - "Xlib: unhandled cookie event copy! extension number = %d, display = %x\n.", - in->extension, dpy); -#endif - return(False); -} - -/*ARGSUSED*/ -Status -_XUnknownNativeEvent( - register Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */ - register XEvent *re, /* pointer to where event should be reformatted */ - register xEvent *event) /* wire protocol event */ -{ -#ifdef notdef - (void) fprintf(stderr, - "Xlib: unhandled native event! event number = %d, display = %x\n.", - re->type, dpy); -#endif - return(0); -} -/* - * reformat a wire event into an XEvent structure of the right type. - */ -Bool -_XWireToEvent( - register Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */ - register XEvent *re, /* pointer to where event should be reformatted */ - register xEvent *event) /* wire protocol event */ -{ - - re->type = event->u.u.type & 0x7f; - ((XAnyEvent *)re)->serial = _XSetLastRequestRead(dpy, - (xGenericReply *)event); - ((XAnyEvent *)re)->send_event = ((event->u.u.type & 0x80) != 0); - ((XAnyEvent *)re)->display = dpy; - - /* Ignore the leading bit of the event type since it is set when a - client sends an event rather than the server. */ - - switch (event-> u.u.type & 0177) { - case KeyPress: - case KeyRelease: - { - register XKeyEvent *ev = (XKeyEvent*) re; - ev->root = event->u.keyButtonPointer.root; - ev->window = event->u.keyButtonPointer.event; - ev->subwindow = event->u.keyButtonPointer.child; - ev->time = event->u.keyButtonPointer.time; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventX); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventY); - ev->x_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootX); - ev->y_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootY); - ev->state = event->u.keyButtonPointer.state; - ev->same_screen = event->u.keyButtonPointer.sameScreen; - ev->keycode = event->u.u.detail; - } - break; - case ButtonPress: - case ButtonRelease: - { - register XButtonEvent *ev = (XButtonEvent *) re; - ev->root = event->u.keyButtonPointer.root; - ev->window = event->u.keyButtonPointer.event; - ev->subwindow = event->u.keyButtonPointer.child; - ev->time = event->u.keyButtonPointer.time; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventX); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventY); - ev->x_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootX); - ev->y_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootY); - ev->state = event->u.keyButtonPointer.state; - ev->same_screen = event->u.keyButtonPointer.sameScreen; - ev->button = event->u.u.detail; - } - break; - case MotionNotify: - { - register XMotionEvent *ev = (XMotionEvent *)re; - ev->root = event->u.keyButtonPointer.root; - ev->window = event->u.keyButtonPointer.event; - ev->subwindow = event->u.keyButtonPointer.child; - ev->time = event->u.keyButtonPointer.time; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventX); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventY); - ev->x_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootX); - ev->y_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootY); - ev->state = event->u.keyButtonPointer.state; - ev->same_screen = event->u.keyButtonPointer.sameScreen; - ev->is_hint = event->u.u.detail; - } - break; - case EnterNotify: - case LeaveNotify: - { - register XCrossingEvent *ev = (XCrossingEvent *) re; - ev->root = event->u.enterLeave.root; - ev->window = event->u.enterLeave.event; - ev->subwindow = event->u.enterLeave.child; - ev->time = event->u.enterLeave.time; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.enterLeave.eventX); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.enterLeave.eventY); - ev->x_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.enterLeave.rootX); - ev->y_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.enterLeave.rootY); - ev->state = event->u.enterLeave.state; - ev->mode = event->u.enterLeave.mode; - ev->same_screen = (event->u.enterLeave.flags & - ELFlagSameScreen) && True; - ev->focus = (event->u.enterLeave.flags & - ELFlagFocus) && True; - ev->detail = event->u.u.detail; - } - break; - case FocusIn: - case FocusOut: - { - register XFocusChangeEvent *ev = (XFocusChangeEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.focus.window; - ev->mode = event->u.focus.mode; - ev->detail = event->u.u.detail; - } - break; - case KeymapNotify: - { - register XKeymapEvent *ev = (XKeymapEvent *) re; - ev->window = None; - memcpy(&ev->key_vector[1], - (char *)((xKeymapEvent *) event)->map, - sizeof (((xKeymapEvent *) event)->map)); - } - break; - case Expose: - { - register XExposeEvent *ev = (XExposeEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.expose.window; - ev->x = event->u.expose.x; - ev->y = event->u.expose.y; - ev->width = event->u.expose.width; - ev->height = event->u.expose.height; - ev->count = event->u.expose.count; - } - break; - case GraphicsExpose: - { - register XGraphicsExposeEvent *ev = - (XGraphicsExposeEvent *) re; - ev->drawable = event->u.graphicsExposure.drawable; - ev->x = event->u.graphicsExposure.x; - ev->y = event->u.graphicsExposure.y; - ev->width = event->u.graphicsExposure.width; - ev->height = event->u.graphicsExposure.height; - ev->count = event->u.graphicsExposure.count; - ev->major_code = event->u.graphicsExposure.majorEvent; - ev->minor_code = event->u.graphicsExposure.minorEvent; - } - break; - case NoExpose: - { - register XNoExposeEvent *ev = (XNoExposeEvent *) re; - ev->drawable = event->u.noExposure.drawable; - ev->major_code = event->u.noExposure.majorEvent; - ev->minor_code = event->u.noExposure.minorEvent; - } - break; - case VisibilityNotify: - { - register XVisibilityEvent *ev = (XVisibilityEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.visibility.window; - ev->state = event->u.visibility.state; - } - break; - case CreateNotify: - { - register XCreateWindowEvent *ev = - (XCreateWindowEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.createNotify.window; - ev->parent = event->u.createNotify.parent; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.createNotify.x); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.createNotify.y); - ev->width = event->u.createNotify.width; - ev->height = event->u.createNotify.height; - ev->border_width = event->u.createNotify.borderWidth; - ev->override_redirect = event->u.createNotify.override; - } - break; - case DestroyNotify: - { - register XDestroyWindowEvent *ev = - (XDestroyWindowEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.destroyNotify.window; - ev->event = event->u.destroyNotify.event; - } - break; - case UnmapNotify: - { - register XUnmapEvent *ev = (XUnmapEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.unmapNotify.window; - ev->event = event->u.unmapNotify.event; - ev->from_configure = event->u.unmapNotify.fromConfigure; - } - break; - case MapNotify: - { - register XMapEvent *ev = (XMapEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.mapNotify.window; - ev->event = event->u.mapNotify.event; - ev->override_redirect = event->u.mapNotify.override; - } - break; - case MapRequest: - { - register XMapRequestEvent *ev = (XMapRequestEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.mapRequest.window; - ev->parent = event->u.mapRequest.parent; - } - break; - case ReparentNotify: - { - register XReparentEvent *ev = (XReparentEvent *) re; - ev->event = event->u.reparent.event; - ev->window = event->u.reparent.window; - ev->parent = event->u.reparent.parent; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.reparent.x); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.reparent.y); - ev->override_redirect = event->u.reparent.override; - } - break; - case ConfigureNotify: - { - register XConfigureEvent *ev = (XConfigureEvent *) re; - ev->event = event->u.configureNotify.event; - ev->window = event->u.configureNotify.window; - ev->above = event->u.configureNotify.aboveSibling; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.configureNotify.x); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.configureNotify.y); - ev->width = event->u.configureNotify.width; - ev->height = event->u.configureNotify.height; - ev->border_width = event->u.configureNotify.borderWidth; - ev->override_redirect = event->u.configureNotify.override; - } - break; - case ConfigureRequest: - { - register XConfigureRequestEvent *ev = - (XConfigureRequestEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.configureRequest.window; - ev->parent = event->u.configureRequest.parent; - ev->above = event->u.configureRequest.sibling; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.configureRequest.x); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.configureRequest.y); - ev->width = event->u.configureRequest.width; - ev->height = event->u.configureRequest.height; - ev->border_width = event->u.configureRequest.borderWidth; - ev->value_mask = event->u.configureRequest.valueMask; - ev->detail = event->u.u.detail; - } - break; - case GravityNotify: - { - register XGravityEvent *ev = (XGravityEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.gravity.window; - ev->event = event->u.gravity.event; - ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.gravity.x); - ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.gravity.y); - } - break; - case ResizeRequest: - { - register XResizeRequestEvent *ev = - (XResizeRequestEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.resizeRequest.window; - ev->width = event->u.resizeRequest.width; - ev->height = event->u.resizeRequest.height; - } - break; - case CirculateNotify: - { - register XCirculateEvent *ev = (XCirculateEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.circulate.window; - ev->event = event->u.circulate.event; - ev->place = event->u.circulate.place; - } - break; - case CirculateRequest: - { - register XCirculateRequestEvent *ev = - (XCirculateRequestEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.circulate.window; - ev->parent = event->u.circulate.event; - ev->place = event->u.circulate.place; - } - break; - case PropertyNotify: - { - register XPropertyEvent *ev = (XPropertyEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.property.window; - ev->atom = event->u.property.atom; - ev->time = event->u.property.time; - ev->state = event->u.property.state; - } - break; - case SelectionClear: - { - register XSelectionClearEvent *ev = - (XSelectionClearEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.selectionClear.window; - ev->selection = event->u.selectionClear.atom; - ev->time = event->u.selectionClear.time; - } - break; - case SelectionRequest: - { - register XSelectionRequestEvent *ev = - (XSelectionRequestEvent *) re; - ev->owner = event->u.selectionRequest.owner; - ev->requestor = event->u.selectionRequest.requestor; - ev->selection = event->u.selectionRequest.selection; - ev->target = event->u.selectionRequest.target; - ev->property = event->u.selectionRequest.property; - ev->time = event->u.selectionRequest.time; - } - break; - case SelectionNotify: - { - register XSelectionEvent *ev = (XSelectionEvent *) re; - ev->requestor = event->u.selectionNotify.requestor; - ev->selection = event->u.selectionNotify.selection; - ev->target = event->u.selectionNotify.target; - ev->property = event->u.selectionNotify.property; - ev->time = event->u.selectionNotify.time; - } - break; - case ColormapNotify: - { - register XColormapEvent *ev = (XColormapEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.colormap.window; - ev->colormap = event->u.colormap.colormap; - ev->new = event->u.colormap.new; - ev->state = event->u.colormap.state; - } - break; - case ClientMessage: - { - register int i; - register XClientMessageEvent *ev - = (XClientMessageEvent *) re; - ev->window = event->u.clientMessage.window; - ev->format = event->u.u.detail; - switch (ev->format) { - case 8: - ev->message_type = event->u.clientMessage.u.b.type; - for (i = 0; i < 20; i++) - ev->data.b[i] = event->u.clientMessage.u.b.bytes[i]; - break; - case 16: - ev->message_type = event->u.clientMessage.u.s.type; - ev->data.s[0] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts0); - ev->data.s[1] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts1); - ev->data.s[2] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts2); - ev->data.s[3] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts3); - ev->data.s[4] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts4); - ev->data.s[5] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts5); - ev->data.s[6] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts6); - ev->data.s[7] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts7); - ev->data.s[8] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts8); - ev->data.s[9] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts9); - break; - case 32: - ev->message_type = event->u.clientMessage.u.l.type; - ev->data.l[0] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs0); - ev->data.l[1] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs1); - ev->data.l[2] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs2); - ev->data.l[3] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs3); - ev->data.l[4] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs4); - break; - default: /* XXX should never occur */ - break; - } - } - break; - case MappingNotify: - { - register XMappingEvent *ev = (XMappingEvent *)re; - ev->window = 0; - ev->first_keycode = event->u.mappingNotify.firstKeyCode; - ev->request = event->u.mappingNotify.request; - ev->count = event->u.mappingNotify.count; - } - break; - default: - return(_XUnknownWireEvent(dpy, re, event)); - } - return(True); -} - - -/* - * _XDefaultIOError - Default fatal system error reporting routine. Called - * when an X internal system error is encountered. - */ -int _XDefaultIOError( - Display *dpy) -{ - if (ECHECK(EPIPE)) { - (void) fprintf (stderr, - "X connection to %s broken (explicit kill or server shutdown).\r\n", - DisplayString (dpy)); - } else { - (void) fprintf (stderr, - "XIO: fatal IO error %d (%s) on X server \"%s\"\r\n", -#ifdef WIN32 - WSAGetLastError(), strerror(WSAGetLastError()), -#else - errno, strerror (errno), -#endif - DisplayString (dpy)); - (void) fprintf (stderr, - " after %lu requests (%lu known processed) with %d events remaining.\r\n", - NextRequest(dpy) - 1, LastKnownRequestProcessed(dpy), - QLength(dpy)); - - } - exit(1); - return(0); /* dummy - function should never return */ -} - - -static int _XPrintDefaultError( - Display *dpy, - XErrorEvent *event, - FILE *fp) -{ - char buffer[BUFSIZ]; - char mesg[BUFSIZ]; - char number[32]; - const char *mtype = "XlibMessage"; - register _XExtension *ext = (_XExtension *)NULL; - _XExtension *bext = (_XExtension *)NULL; - XGetErrorText(dpy, event->error_code, buffer, BUFSIZ); - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "XError", "X Error", mesg, BUFSIZ); - (void) fprintf(fp, "%s: %s\n ", mesg, buffer); - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "MajorCode", "Request Major code %d", - mesg, BUFSIZ); - (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->request_code); - if (event->request_code < 128) { - sprintf(number, "%d", event->request_code); - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, "XRequest", number, "", buffer, BUFSIZ); - } else { - for (ext = dpy->ext_procs; - ext && (ext->codes.major_opcode != event->request_code); - ext = ext->next) - ; - if (ext) { - strncpy(buffer, ext->name, BUFSIZ); - buffer[BUFSIZ - 1] = '\0'; - } else - buffer[0] = '\0'; - } - (void) fprintf(fp, " (%s)\n", buffer); - if (event->request_code >= 128) { - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "MinorCode", "Request Minor code %d", - mesg, BUFSIZ); - fputs(" ", fp); - (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->minor_code); - if (ext) { - sprintf(mesg, "%s.%d", ext->name, event->minor_code); - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, "XRequest", mesg, "", buffer, BUFSIZ); - (void) fprintf(fp, " (%s)", buffer); - } - fputs("\n", fp); - } - if (event->error_code >= 128) { - /* kludge, try to find the extension that caused it */ - buffer[0] = '\0'; - for (ext = dpy->ext_procs; ext; ext = ext->next) { - if (ext->error_string) - (*ext->error_string)(dpy, event->error_code, &ext->codes, - buffer, BUFSIZ); - if (buffer[0]) { - bext = ext; - break; - } - if (ext->codes.first_error && - ext->codes.first_error < (int)event->error_code && - (!bext || ext->codes.first_error > bext->codes.first_error)) - bext = ext; - } - if (bext) - sprintf(buffer, "%s.%d", bext->name, - event->error_code - bext->codes.first_error); - else - strcpy(buffer, "Value"); - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, buffer, "", mesg, BUFSIZ); - if (mesg[0]) { - fputs(" ", fp); - (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->resourceid); - fputs("\n", fp); - } - /* let extensions try to print the values */ - for (ext = dpy->ext_procs; ext; ext = ext->next) { - if (ext->error_values) - (*ext->error_values)(dpy, event, fp); - } - } else if ((event->error_code == BadWindow) || - (event->error_code == BadPixmap) || - (event->error_code == BadCursor) || - (event->error_code == BadFont) || - (event->error_code == BadDrawable) || - (event->error_code == BadColor) || - (event->error_code == BadGC) || - (event->error_code == BadIDChoice) || - (event->error_code == BadValue) || - (event->error_code == BadAtom)) { - if (event->error_code == BadValue) - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "Value", "Value 0x%x", - mesg, BUFSIZ); - else if (event->error_code == BadAtom) - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "AtomID", "AtomID 0x%x", - mesg, BUFSIZ); - else - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "ResourceID", "ResourceID 0x%x", - mesg, BUFSIZ); - fputs(" ", fp); - (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->resourceid); - fputs("\n", fp); - } - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "ErrorSerial", "Error Serial #%d", - mesg, BUFSIZ); - fputs(" ", fp); - (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->serial); - XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "CurrentSerial", "Current Serial #%d", - mesg, BUFSIZ); - fputs("\n ", fp); - (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, dpy->request); - fputs("\n", fp); - if (event->error_code == BadImplementation) return 0; - return 1; -} - -int _XDefaultError( - Display *dpy, - XErrorEvent *event) -{ - if (_XPrintDefaultError (dpy, event, stderr) == 0) return 0; - exit(1); - /*NOTREACHED*/ -} - -/*ARGSUSED*/ -Bool _XDefaultWireError(Display *display, XErrorEvent *he, xError *we) -{ - return True; -} - -/* - * _XError - upcall internal or user protocol error handler - */ -int _XError ( - Display *dpy, - register xError *rep) -{ - /* - * X_Error packet encountered! We need to unpack the error before - * giving it to the user. - */ - XEvent event; /* make it a large event */ - register _XAsyncHandler *async, *next; - - event.xerror.serial = _XSetLastRequestRead(dpy, (xGenericReply *)rep); - - for (async = dpy->async_handlers; async; async = next) { - next = async->next; - if ((*async->handler)(dpy, (xReply *)rep, - (char *)rep, SIZEOF(xError), async->data)) - return 0; - } - - event.xerror.display = dpy; - event.xerror.type = X_Error; - event.xerror.resourceid = rep->resourceID; - event.xerror.error_code = rep->errorCode; - event.xerror.request_code = rep->majorCode; - event.xerror.minor_code = rep->minorCode; - if (dpy->error_vec && - !(*dpy->error_vec[rep->errorCode])(dpy, &event.xerror, rep)) - return 0; - if (_XErrorFunction != NULL) { - return (*_XErrorFunction)(dpy, (XErrorEvent *)&event); /* upcall */ - } else { - return _XDefaultError(dpy, (XErrorEvent *)&event); - } -} - -/* - * _XIOError - call user connection error handler and exit - */ -int -_XIOError ( - Display *dpy) -{ - dpy->flags |= XlibDisplayIOError; -#ifdef WIN32 - errno = WSAGetLastError(); -#endif - - /* This assumes that the thread calling exit will call any atexit handlers. - * If this does not hold, then an alternate solution would involve - * registering an atexit handler to take over the lock, which would only - * assume that the same thread calls all the atexit handlers. */ -#ifdef XTHREADS - if (dpy->lock) - (*dpy->lock->user_lock_display)(dpy); -#endif - UnlockDisplay(dpy); - - if (_XIOErrorFunction != NULL) - (*_XIOErrorFunction)(dpy); - else - _XDefaultIOError(dpy); - exit (1); - return 0; -} - - -/* - * This routine can be used to (cheaply) get some memory within a single - * Xlib routine for scratch space. A single buffer is reused each time - * if possible. To be MT safe, you can only call this between a call to - * GetReq* and a call to Data* or _XSend*, or in a context when the thread - * is guaranteed to not unlock the display. - */ -char *_XAllocScratch( - register Display *dpy, - unsigned long nbytes) -{ - if (nbytes > dpy->scratch_length) { - if (dpy->scratch_buffer) Xfree (dpy->scratch_buffer); - if ((dpy->scratch_buffer = Xmalloc((unsigned) nbytes))) - dpy->scratch_length = nbytes; - else dpy->scratch_length = 0; - } - return (dpy->scratch_buffer); -} - -/* - * Scratch space allocator you can call any time, multiple times, and be - * MT safe, but you must hand the buffer back with _XFreeTemp. - */ -char *_XAllocTemp( - register Display *dpy, - unsigned long nbytes) -{ - char *buf; - - buf = _XAllocScratch(dpy, nbytes); - dpy->scratch_buffer = NULL; - dpy->scratch_length = 0; - return buf; -} - -void _XFreeTemp( - register Display *dpy, - char *buf, - unsigned long nbytes) -{ - if (dpy->scratch_buffer) - Xfree(dpy->scratch_buffer); - dpy->scratch_buffer = buf; - dpy->scratch_length = nbytes; -} - -/* - * Given a visual id, find the visual structure for this id on this display. - */ -Visual *_XVIDtoVisual( - Display *dpy, - VisualID id) -{ - register int i, j, k; - register Screen *sp; - register Depth *dp; - register Visual *vp; - for (i = 0; i < dpy->nscreens; i++) { - sp = &dpy->screens[i]; - for (j = 0; j < sp->ndepths; j++) { - dp = &sp->depths[j]; - /* if nvisuals == 0 then visuals will be NULL */ - for (k = 0; k < dp->nvisuals; k++) { - vp = &dp->visuals[k]; - if (vp->visualid == id) return (vp); - } - } - } - return (NULL); -} - -int -XFree (void *data) -{ - Xfree (data); - return 1; -} - -#ifdef _XNEEDBCOPYFUNC -void _Xbcopy(b1, b2, length) - register char *b1, *b2; - register length; -{ - if (b1 < b2) { - b2 += length; - b1 += length; - while (length--) - *--b2 = *--b1; - } else { - while (length--) - *b2++ = *b1++; - } -} -#endif - -#ifdef DataRoutineIsProcedure -void Data( - Display *dpy, - char *data, - long len) -{ - if (dpy->bufptr + (len) <= dpy->bufmax) { - memcpy(dpy->bufptr, data, (int)len); - dpy->bufptr += ((len) + 3) & ~3; - } else { - _XSend(dpy, data, len); - } -} -#endif /* DataRoutineIsProcedure */ - - -#ifdef LONG64 -int -_XData32( - Display *dpy, - register long *data, - unsigned len) -{ - register int *buf; - register long i; - - while (len) { - buf = (int *)dpy->bufptr; - i = dpy->bufmax - (char *)buf; - if (!i) { - _XFlush(dpy); - continue; - } - if (len < i) - i = len; - dpy->bufptr = (char *)buf + i; - len -= i; - i >>= 2; - while (--i >= 0) - *buf++ = *data++; - } - return 0; -} -#endif /* LONG64 */ - -#ifdef WORD64 - -/* - * XXX This is a *really* stupid way of doing this. It should just use - * dpy->bufptr directly, taking into account where in the word it is. - */ - -/* - * Data16 - Place 16 bit data in the buffer. - * - * "dpy" is a pointer to a Display. - * "data" is a pointer to the data. - * "len" is the length in bytes of the data. - */ - -static doData16( - register Display *dpy, - short *data, - unsigned len, - char *packbuffer) -{ - long *lp,*lpack; - long i, nwords,bits; - long mask16 = 0x000000000000ffff; - - lp = (long *)data; - lpack = (long *)packbuffer; - -/* nwords is the number of 16 bit values to be packed, - * the low order 16 bits of each word will be packed - * into 64 bit words - */ - nwords = len >> 1; - bits = 48; - - for(i=0;i<nwords;i++){ - if (bits == 48) *lpack = 0; - *lpack ^= (*lp & mask16) << bits; - bits -= 16 ; - lp++; - if(bits < 0){ - lpack++; - bits = 48; - } - } - Data(dpy, packbuffer, len); -} - -_XData16 ( - Display *dpy, - short *data, - unsigned len) -{ - char packbuffer[PACKBUFFERSIZE]; - unsigned nunits = PACKBUFFERSIZE >> 1; - - for (; len > PACKBUFFERSIZE; len -= PACKBUFFERSIZE, data += nunits) { - doData16 (dpy, data, PACKBUFFERSIZE, packbuffer); - } - if (len) doData16 (dpy, data, len, packbuffer); -} - -/* - * Data32 - Place 32 bit data in the buffer. - * - * "dpy" is a pointer to a Display. - * "data" is a pointer to the data. - * "len" is the length in bytes of the data. - */ - -static doData32( - register Display *dpy - long *data, - unsigned len, - char *packbuffer) -{ - long *lp,*lpack; - long i,bits,nwords; - long mask32 = 0x00000000ffffffff; - - lpack = (long *) packbuffer; - lp = data; - -/* nwords is the number of 32 bit values to be packed - * the low order 32 bits of each word will be packed - * into 64 bit words - */ - nwords = len >> 2; - bits = 32; - - for(i=0;i<nwords;i++){ - if (bits == 32) *lpack = 0; - *lpack ^= (*lp & mask32) << bits; - bits = bits ^32; - lp++; - if(bits) - lpack++; - } - Data(dpy, packbuffer, len); -} - -void _XData32( - Display *dpy, - long *data, - unsigned len) -{ - char packbuffer[PACKBUFFERSIZE]; - unsigned nunits = PACKBUFFERSIZE >> 2; - - for (; len > PACKBUFFERSIZE; len -= PACKBUFFERSIZE, data += nunits) { - doData32 (dpy, data, PACKBUFFERSIZE, packbuffer); - } - if (len) doData32 (dpy, data, len, packbuffer); -} - -#endif /* WORD64 */ - - -/* Make sure this produces the same string as DefineLocal/DefineSelf in xdm. - * Otherwise, Xau will not be able to find your cookies in the Xauthority file. - * - * Note: POSIX says that the ``nodename'' member of utsname does _not_ have - * to have sufficient information for interfacing to the network, - * and so, you may be better off using gethostname (if it exists). - */ - -#if (defined(_POSIX_SOURCE) && !defined(AIXV3) && !defined(__QNX__)) || defined(hpux) || defined(SVR4) -#define NEED_UTSNAME -#include <sys/utsname.h> -#else -#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H -#include <unistd.h> -#endif -#endif - -/* - * _XGetHostname - similar to gethostname but allows special processing. - */ -int _XGetHostname ( - char *buf, - int maxlen) -{ - int len; - -#ifdef NEED_UTSNAME - struct utsname name; - - if (maxlen <= 0 || buf == NULL) - return 0; - - uname (&name); - len = strlen (name.nodename); - if (len >= maxlen) len = maxlen - 1; - strncpy (buf, name.nodename, len); - buf[len] = '\0'; -#else - if (maxlen <= 0 || buf == NULL) - return 0; - - buf[0] = '\0'; - (void) gethostname (buf, maxlen); - buf [maxlen - 1] = '\0'; - len = strlen(buf); -#endif /* NEED_UTSNAME */ - return len; -} - - -/* - * _XScreenOfWindow - get the Screen of a given window - */ - -Screen *_XScreenOfWindow(Display *dpy, Window w) -{ - register int i; - Window root; - int x, y; /* dummy variables */ - unsigned int width, height, bw, depth; /* dummy variables */ - - if (XGetGeometry (dpy, w, &root, &x, &y, &width, &height, - &bw, &depth) == False) { - return NULL; - } - for (i = 0; i < ScreenCount (dpy); i++) { /* find root from list */ - if (root == RootWindow (dpy, i)) { - return ScreenOfDisplay (dpy, i); - } - } - return NULL; -} - - -#if defined(WIN32) - -/* - * These functions are intended to be used internally to Xlib only. - * These functions will always prefix the path with a DOS drive in the - * form "<drive-letter>:". As such, these functions are only suitable - * for use by Xlib function that supply a root-based path to some - * particular file, e.g. <ProjectRoot>/lib/X11/locale/locale.dir will - * be converted to "C:/usr/X11R6.3/lib/X11/locale/locale.dir". - */ - -static int access_file (path, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret) - char* path; - char* pathbuf; - int len_pathbuf; - char** pathret; -{ - if (access (path, F_OK) == 0) { - if (strlen (path) < len_pathbuf) - *pathret = pathbuf; - else - *pathret = Xmalloc (strlen (path) + 1); - if (*pathret) { - strcpy (*pathret, path); - return 1; - } - } - return 0; -} - -static int AccessFile (path, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret) - char* path; - char* pathbuf; - int len_pathbuf; - char** pathret; -{ - unsigned long drives; - int i, len; - char* drive; - char buf[MAX_PATH]; - char* bufp; - - /* just try the "raw" name first and see if it works */ - if (access_file (path, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)) - return 1; - - /* try the places set in the environment */ - drive = getenv ("_XBASEDRIVE"); -#ifdef __UNIXOS2__ - if (!drive) - drive = getenv ("X11ROOT"); -#endif - if (!drive) - drive = "C:"; - len = strlen (drive) + strlen (path); - if (len < MAX_PATH) bufp = buf; - else bufp = Xmalloc (len + 1); - strcpy (bufp, drive); - strcat (bufp, path); - if (access_file (bufp, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)) { - if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp); - return 1; - } - -#ifndef __UNIXOS2__ - /* one last place to look */ - drive = getenv ("HOMEDRIVE"); - if (drive) { - len = strlen (drive) + strlen (path); - if (len < MAX_PATH) bufp = buf; - else bufp = Xmalloc (len + 1); - strcpy (bufp, drive); - strcat (bufp, path); - if (access_file (bufp, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)) { - if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp); - return 1; - } - } - - /* tried everywhere else, go fishing */ -#define C_DRIVE ('C' - 'A') -#define Z_DRIVE ('Z' - 'A') - /* does OS/2 (with or with gcc-emx) have getdrives? */ - drives = _getdrives (); - for (i = C_DRIVE; i <= Z_DRIVE; i++) { /* don't check on A: or B: */ - if ((1 << i) & drives) { - len = 2 + strlen (path); - if (len < MAX_PATH) bufp = buf; - else bufp = Xmalloc (len + 1); - *bufp = 'A' + i; - *(bufp + 1) = ':'; - *(bufp + 2) = '\0'; - strcat (bufp, path); - if (access_file (bufp, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)) { - if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp); - return 1; - } - } - } -#endif - return 0; -} - -int _XOpenFile(path, flags) - _Xconst char* path; - int flags; -{ - char buf[MAX_PATH]; - char* bufp = NULL; - int ret = -1; - UINT olderror = SetErrorMode (SEM_FAILCRITICALERRORS); - - if (AccessFile (path, buf, MAX_PATH, &bufp)) - ret = open (bufp, flags); - - (void) SetErrorMode (olderror); - - if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp); - - return ret; -} - -int _XOpenFileMode(path, flags, mode) - _Xconst char* path; - int flags; - mode_t mode; -{ - char buf[MAX_PATH]; - char* bufp = NULL; - int ret = -1; - UINT olderror = SetErrorMode (SEM_FAILCRITICALERRORS); - - if (AccessFile (path, buf, MAX_PATH, &bufp)) - ret = open (bufp, flags, mode); - - (void) SetErrorMode (olderror); - - if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp); - - return ret; -} - -void* _XFopenFile(path, mode) - _Xconst char* path; - _Xconst char* mode; -{ - char buf[MAX_PATH]; - char* bufp = NULL; - void* ret = NULL; - UINT olderror = SetErrorMode (SEM_FAILCRITICALERRORS); - - if (AccessFile (path, buf, MAX_PATH, &bufp)) - ret = fopen (bufp, mode); - - (void) SetErrorMode (olderror); - - if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp); - - return ret; -} - -int _XAccessFile(path) - _Xconst char* path; -{ - char buf[MAX_PATH]; - char* bufp; - int ret = -1; - UINT olderror = SetErrorMode (SEM_FAILCRITICALERRORS); - - ret = AccessFile (path, buf, MAX_PATH, &bufp); - - (void) SetErrorMode (olderror); - - if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp); - - return ret; -} - -#endif - -#ifdef WIN32 -#undef _Xdebug -int _Xdebug = 0; -int *_Xdebug_p = &_Xdebug; -void (**_XCreateMutex_fn_p)(LockInfoPtr) = &_XCreateMutex_fn; -void (**_XFreeMutex_fn_p)(LockInfoPtr) = &_XFreeMutex_fn; -void (**_XLockMutex_fn_p)(LockInfoPtr -#if defined(XTHREADS_WARN) || defined(XTHREADS_FILE_LINE) - , char * /* file */ - , int /* line */ -#endif - ) = &_XLockMutex_fn; -void (**_XUnlockMutex_fn_p)(LockInfoPtr -#if defined(XTHREADS_WARN) || defined(XTHREADS_FILE_LINE) - , char * /* file */ - , int /* line */ -#endif - ) = &_XUnlockMutex_fn; -LockInfoPtr *_Xglobal_lock_p = &_Xglobal_lock; -#endif +/*
+
+Copyright 1985, 1986, 1987, 1998 The Open Group
+
+Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software and its
+documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided that
+the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that
+copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting
+documentation.
+
+The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included
+in all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+
+THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS
+OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
+MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT.
+IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OPEN GROUP BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
+OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
+ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
+OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+
+Except as contained in this notice, the name of The Open Group shall
+not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or
+other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization
+from The Open Group.
+
+*/
+
+/*
+ * XlibInt.c - Internal support routines for the C subroutine
+ * interface library (Xlib) to the X Window System Protocol V11.0.
+ */
+
+#ifdef WIN32
+#define _XLIBINT_
+#include <X11\Xw32defs.h>
+#endif
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+#include <config.h>
+#endif
+#include "Xlibint.h"
+#include "Xprivate.h"
+#include <X11/Xpoll.h>
+#include <assert.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#ifdef WIN32
+#include <direct.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef XTHREADS
+#include "locking.h"
+
+/* these pointers get initialized by XInitThreads */
+LockInfoPtr _Xglobal_lock = NULL;
+void (*_XCreateMutex_fn)(LockInfoPtr) = NULL;
+/* struct _XCVList *(*_XCreateCVL_fn)() = NULL; */
+void (*_XFreeMutex_fn)(LockInfoPtr) = NULL;
+void (*_XLockMutex_fn)(
+ LockInfoPtr /* lock */
+#if defined(XTHREADS_WARN) || defined(XTHREADS_FILE_LINE)
+ , char * /* file */
+ , int /* line */
+#endif
+ ) = NULL;
+void (*_XUnlockMutex_fn)(
+ LockInfoPtr /* lock */
+#if defined(XTHREADS_WARN) || defined(XTHREADS_FILE_LINE)
+ , char * /* file */
+ , int /* line */
+#endif
+ ) = NULL;
+xthread_t (*_Xthread_self_fn)(void) = NULL;
+
+#define XThread_Self() ((*_Xthread_self_fn)())
+
+#endif /* XTHREADS */
+
+/* check for both EAGAIN and EWOULDBLOCK, because some supposedly POSIX
+ * systems are broken and return EWOULDBLOCK when they should return EAGAIN
+ */
+#ifdef WIN32
+#define ETEST() (WSAGetLastError() == WSAEWOULDBLOCK)
+#else
+#ifdef __CYGWIN__ /* Cygwin uses ENOBUFS to signal socket is full */
+#define ETEST() (errno == EAGAIN || errno == EWOULDBLOCK || errno == ENOBUFS)
+#else
+#if defined(EAGAIN) && defined(EWOULDBLOCK)
+#define ETEST() (errno == EAGAIN || errno == EWOULDBLOCK)
+#else
+#ifdef EAGAIN
+#define ETEST() (errno == EAGAIN)
+#else
+#define ETEST() (errno == EWOULDBLOCK)
+#endif /* EAGAIN */
+#endif /* EAGAIN && EWOULDBLOCK */
+#endif /* __CYGWIN__ */
+#endif /* WIN32 */
+
+#ifdef WIN32
+#define ECHECK(err) (WSAGetLastError() == err)
+#define ESET(val) WSASetLastError(val)
+#else
+#ifdef __UNIXOS2__
+#define ECHECK(err) (errno == err)
+#define ESET(val)
+#else
+#define ECHECK(err) (errno == err)
+#define ESET(val) errno = val
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#if defined(LOCALCONN) || defined(LACHMAN)
+#ifdef EMSGSIZE
+#define ESZTEST() (ECHECK(EMSGSIZE) || ECHECK(ERANGE))
+#else
+#define ESZTEST() ECHECK(ERANGE)
+#endif
+#else
+#ifdef EMSGSIZE
+#define ESZTEST() ECHECK(EMSGSIZE)
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __UNIXOS2__
+#include <limits.h>
+#define MAX_PATH _POSIX_PATH_MAX
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * The following routines are internal routines used by Xlib for protocol
+ * packet transmission and reception.
+ *
+ * _XIOError(Display *) will be called if any sort of system call error occurs.
+ * This is assumed to be a fatal condition, i.e., XIOError should not return.
+ *
+ * _XError(Display *, xError *) will be called whenever an X_Error event is
+ * received. This is not assumed to be a fatal condition, i.e., it is
+ * acceptable for this procedure to return. However, XError should NOT
+ * perform any operations (directly or indirectly) on the DISPLAY.
+ *
+ * Routines declared with a return type of 'Status' return 0 on failure,
+ * and non 0 on success. Routines with no declared return type don't
+ * return anything. Whenever possible routines that create objects return
+ * the object they have created.
+ */
+
+#define POLLFD_CACHE_SIZE 5
+
+#if _WIN32_WINNT < _WIN32_WINNT_VISTA
+struct pollfd {
+
+ SOCKET fd;
+ SHORT events;
+ SHORT revents;
+
+};
+#define POLLRDNORM 0x0100
+#define POLLRDBAND 0x0200
+#define POLLIN (POLLRDNORM | POLLRDBAND)
+#endif
+
+/* initialize the struct array passed to poll() below */
+Bool _XPollfdCacheInit(
+ Display *dpy)
+{
+#ifdef USE_POLL
+ struct pollfd *pfp;
+
+ pfp = (struct pollfd *)Xmalloc(POLLFD_CACHE_SIZE * sizeof(struct pollfd));
+ if (!pfp)
+ return False;
+ pfp[0].fd = dpy->fd;
+ pfp[0].events = POLLIN;
+
+ dpy->filedes = (XPointer)pfp;
+#endif
+ return True;
+}
+
+void _XPollfdCacheAdd(
+ Display *dpy,
+ int fd)
+{
+#ifdef USE_POLL
+ struct pollfd *pfp = (struct pollfd *)dpy->filedes;
+
+ if (dpy->im_fd_length <= POLLFD_CACHE_SIZE) {
+ pfp[dpy->im_fd_length].fd = fd;
+ pfp[dpy->im_fd_length].events = POLLIN;
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/* ARGSUSED */
+void _XPollfdCacheDel(
+ Display *dpy,
+ int fd) /* not used */
+{
+#ifdef USE_POLL
+ struct pollfd *pfp = (struct pollfd *)dpy->filedes;
+ struct _XConnectionInfo *conni;
+
+ /* just recalculate whole list */
+ if (dpy->im_fd_length <= POLLFD_CACHE_SIZE) {
+ int loc = 1;
+ for (conni = dpy->im_fd_info; conni; conni=conni->next) {
+ pfp[loc].fd = conni->fd;
+ pfp[loc].events = POLLIN;
+ loc++;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#undef min
+#define min __min
+#endif
+
+static int sync_hazard(Display *dpy)
+{
+ unsigned long span = dpy->request - dpy->last_request_read;
+ unsigned long hazard = min((dpy->bufmax - dpy->buffer) / SIZEOF(xReq), 65535 - 10);
+ return span >= 65535 - hazard - 10;
+}
+
+static
+void sync_while_locked(Display *dpy)
+{
+#ifdef XTHREADS
+ if (dpy->lock)
+ (*dpy->lock->user_lock_display)(dpy);
+#endif
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+ SyncHandle();
+ InternalLockDisplay(dpy, /* don't skip user locks */ 0);
+#ifdef XTHREADS
+ if (dpy->lock)
+ (*dpy->lock->user_unlock_display)(dpy);
+#endif
+}
+
+void _XSeqSyncFunction(
+ register Display *dpy)
+{
+ xGetInputFocusReply rep;
+ register xReq *req;
+
+ if ((dpy->request - dpy->last_request_read) >= (65535 - BUFSIZE/SIZEOF(xReq))) {
+ GetEmptyReq(GetInputFocus, req);
+ (void) _XReply (dpy, (xReply *)&rep, 0, xTrue);
+ sync_while_locked(dpy);
+ } else if (sync_hazard(dpy))
+ _XSetPrivSyncFunction(dpy);
+}
+
+/* NOTE: only called if !XTHREADS, or when XInitThreads wasn't called. */
+static int
+_XPrivSyncFunction (Display *dpy)
+{
+#ifdef XTHREADS
+ assert(!dpy->lock_fns);
+#endif
+ assert(dpy->synchandler == _XPrivSyncFunction);
+ assert((dpy->flags & XlibDisplayPrivSync) != 0);
+ dpy->synchandler = dpy->savedsynchandler;
+ dpy->savedsynchandler = NULL;
+ dpy->flags &= ~XlibDisplayPrivSync;
+ if(dpy->synchandler)
+ dpy->synchandler(dpy);
+ _XIDHandler(dpy);
+ _XSeqSyncFunction(dpy);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+void _XSetPrivSyncFunction(Display *dpy)
+{
+#ifdef XTHREADS
+ if (dpy->lock_fns)
+ return;
+#endif
+ if (!(dpy->flags & XlibDisplayPrivSync)) {
+ dpy->savedsynchandler = dpy->synchandler;
+ dpy->synchandler = _XPrivSyncFunction;
+ dpy->flags |= XlibDisplayPrivSync;
+ }
+}
+
+void _XSetSeqSyncFunction(Display *dpy)
+{
+ if (sync_hazard(dpy))
+ _XSetPrivSyncFunction (dpy);
+}
+
+#ifdef LONG64
+void _XRead32(
+ Display *dpy,
+ register long *data,
+ long len)
+{
+ register int *buf;
+ register long i;
+
+ if (len) {
+ (void) _XRead(dpy, (char *)data, len);
+ i = len >> 2;
+ buf = (int *)data + i;
+ data += i;
+ while (--i >= 0)
+ *--data = *--buf;
+ }
+}
+#endif /* LONG64 */
+
+#ifdef WORD64
+
+/*
+ * XXX This is a *really* stupid way of doing this....
+ * PACKBUFFERSIZE must be a multiple of 4.
+ */
+
+#define PACKBUFFERSIZE 4096
+
+
+/*
+ * _XRead32 - Read bytes from the socket unpacking each 32 bits
+ * into a long (64 bits on a CRAY computer).
+ *
+ */
+static void _doXRead32(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ register long *data
+ register long size,
+ register char *packbuffer)
+{
+ long *lpack,*lp;
+ long mask32 = 0x00000000ffffffff;
+ long maskw, nwords, i, bits;
+
+ _XReadPad (dpy, packbuffer, size);
+
+ lp = data;
+ lpack = (long *) packbuffer;
+ nwords = size >> 2;
+ bits = 32;
+
+ for(i=0;i<nwords;i++){
+ maskw = mask32 << bits;
+ *lp++ = ( *lpack & maskw ) >> bits;
+ bits = bits ^32;
+ if(bits){
+ lpack++;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+void _XRead32(
+ Display *dpy,
+ long *data,
+ long len)
+{
+ char packbuffer[PACKBUFFERSIZE];
+ unsigned nunits = PACKBUFFERSIZE >> 2;
+
+ for (; len > PACKBUFFERSIZE; len -= PACKBUFFERSIZE, data += nunits) {
+ _doXRead32 (dpy, data, PACKBUFFERSIZE, packbuffer);
+ }
+ if (len) _doXRead32 (dpy, data, len, packbuffer);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * _XRead16 - Read bytes from the socket unpacking each 16 bits
+ * into a long (64 bits on a CRAY computer).
+ *
+ */
+static _doXRead16(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ register short *data,
+ register long size,
+ char *packbuffer)
+{
+ long *lpack,*lp;
+ long mask16 = 0x000000000000ffff;
+ long maskw, nwords, i, bits;
+
+ (void) _XRead(dpy,packbuffer,size); /* don't do a padded read... */
+
+ lp = (long *) data;
+ lpack = (long *) packbuffer;
+ nwords = size >> 1; /* number of 16 bit words to be unpacked */
+ bits = 48;
+ for(i=0;i<nwords;i++){
+ maskw = mask16 << bits;
+ *lp++ = ( *lpack & maskw ) >> bits;
+ bits -= 16;
+ if(bits < 0){
+ lpack++;
+ bits = 48;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+void _XRead16(
+ Display *dpy,
+ short *data,
+ long len)
+{
+ char packbuffer[PACKBUFFERSIZE];
+ unsigned nunits = PACKBUFFERSIZE >> 1;
+
+ for (; len > PACKBUFFERSIZE; len -= PACKBUFFERSIZE, data += nunits) {
+ _doXRead16 (dpy, data, PACKBUFFERSIZE, packbuffer);
+ }
+ if (len) _doXRead16 (dpy, data, len, packbuffer);
+}
+
+void _XRead16Pad(
+ Display *dpy,
+ short *data,
+ long size)
+{
+ int slop = (size & 3);
+ short slopbuf[3];
+
+ _XRead16 (dpy, data, size);
+ if (slop > 0) {
+ _XRead16 (dpy, slopbuf, 4 - slop);
+ }
+}
+#endif /* WORD64 */
+
+/*
+ * The hard part about this is that we only get 16 bits from a reply.
+ * We have three values that will march along, with the following invariant:
+ * dpy->last_request_read <= rep->sequenceNumber <= dpy->request
+ * We have to keep
+ * dpy->request - dpy->last_request_read < 2^16
+ * or else we won't know for sure what value to use in events. We do this
+ * by forcing syncs when we get close.
+ */
+
+unsigned long
+_XSetLastRequestRead(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ register xGenericReply *rep)
+{
+ register unsigned long newseq, lastseq;
+
+ lastseq = dpy->last_request_read;
+ /*
+ * KeymapNotify has no sequence number, but is always guaranteed
+ * to immediately follow another event, except when generated via
+ * SendEvent (hmmm).
+ */
+ if ((rep->type & 0x7f) == KeymapNotify)
+ return(lastseq);
+
+ newseq = (lastseq & ~((unsigned long)0xffff)) | rep->sequenceNumber;
+
+ if (newseq < lastseq) {
+ newseq += 0x10000;
+ if (newseq > dpy->request) {
+ (void) fprintf (stderr,
+ "Xlib: sequence lost (0x%lx > 0x%lx) in reply type 0x%x!\n",
+ newseq, dpy->request,
+ (unsigned int) rep->type);
+ newseq -= 0x10000;
+ }
+ }
+
+ dpy->last_request_read = newseq;
+ return(newseq);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Support for internal connections, such as an IM might use.
+ * By Stephen Gildea, X Consortium, September 1993
+ */
+
+/* _XRegisterInternalConnection
+ * Each IM (or Xlib extension) that opens a file descriptor that Xlib should
+ * include in its select/poll mask must call this function to register the
+ * fd with Xlib. Any XConnectionWatchProc registered by XAddConnectionWatch
+ * will also be called.
+ *
+ * Whenever Xlib detects input available on fd, it will call callback
+ * with call_data to process it. If non-Xlib code calls select/poll
+ * and detects input available, it must call XProcessInternalConnection,
+ * which will call the associated callback.
+ *
+ * Non-Xlib code can learn about these additional fds by calling
+ * XInternalConnectionNumbers or, more typically, by registering
+ * a XConnectionWatchProc with XAddConnectionWatch
+ * to be called when fds are registered or unregistered.
+ *
+ * Returns True if registration succeeded, False if not, typically
+ * because could not allocate memory.
+ * Assumes Display locked when called.
+ */
+Status
+_XRegisterInternalConnection(
+ Display* dpy,
+ int fd,
+ _XInternalConnectionProc callback,
+ XPointer call_data
+)
+{
+ struct _XConnectionInfo *new_conni, **iptr;
+ struct _XConnWatchInfo *watchers;
+ XPointer *wd;
+
+ new_conni = (struct _XConnectionInfo*)Xmalloc(sizeof(struct _XConnectionInfo));
+ if (!new_conni)
+ return 0;
+ new_conni->watch_data = (XPointer *)Xmalloc(dpy->watcher_count * sizeof(XPointer));
+ if (!new_conni->watch_data) {
+ Xfree(new_conni);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ new_conni->fd = fd;
+ new_conni->read_callback = callback;
+ new_conni->call_data = call_data;
+ new_conni->next = NULL;
+ /* link new structure onto end of list */
+ for (iptr = &dpy->im_fd_info; *iptr; iptr = &(*iptr)->next)
+ ;
+ *iptr = new_conni;
+ dpy->im_fd_length++;
+ _XPollfdCacheAdd(dpy, fd);
+
+ for (watchers=dpy->conn_watchers, wd=new_conni->watch_data;
+ watchers;
+ watchers=watchers->next, wd++) {
+ *wd = NULL; /* for cleanliness */
+ (*watchers->fn) (dpy, watchers->client_data, fd, True, wd);
+ }
+
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* _XUnregisterInternalConnection
+ * Each IM (or Xlib extension) that closes a file descriptor previously
+ * registered with _XRegisterInternalConnection must call this function.
+ * Any XConnectionWatchProc registered by XAddConnectionWatch
+ * will also be called.
+ *
+ * Assumes Display locked when called.
+ */
+void
+_XUnregisterInternalConnection(
+ Display* dpy,
+ int fd
+)
+{
+ struct _XConnectionInfo *info_list, **prev;
+ struct _XConnWatchInfo *watch;
+ XPointer *wd;
+
+ for (prev = &dpy->im_fd_info; (info_list = *prev);
+ prev = &info_list->next) {
+ if (info_list->fd == fd) {
+ *prev = info_list->next;
+ dpy->im_fd_length--;
+ for (watch=dpy->conn_watchers, wd=info_list->watch_data;
+ watch;
+ watch=watch->next, wd++) {
+ (*watch->fn) (dpy, watch->client_data, fd, False, wd);
+ }
+ if (info_list->watch_data)
+ Xfree (info_list->watch_data);
+ Xfree (info_list);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ _XPollfdCacheDel(dpy, fd);
+}
+
+/* XInternalConnectionNumbers
+ * Returns an array of fds and an array of corresponding call data.
+ * Typically a XConnectionWatchProc registered with XAddConnectionWatch
+ * will be used instead of this function to discover
+ * additional fds to include in the select/poll mask.
+ *
+ * The list is allocated with Xmalloc and should be freed by the caller
+ * with Xfree;
+ */
+Status
+XInternalConnectionNumbers(
+ Display *dpy,
+ int **fd_return,
+ int *count_return
+)
+{
+ int count;
+ struct _XConnectionInfo *info_list;
+ int *fd_list;
+
+ LockDisplay(dpy);
+ count = 0;
+ for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next)
+ count++;
+ fd_list = (int*) Xmalloc (count * sizeof(int));
+ if (!fd_list) {
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ count = 0;
+ for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) {
+ fd_list[count] = info_list->fd;
+ count++;
+ }
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+
+ *fd_return = fd_list;
+ *count_return = count;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+void _XProcessInternalConnection(
+ Display *dpy,
+ struct _XConnectionInfo *conn_info)
+{
+ dpy->flags |= XlibDisplayProcConni;
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+ (*conn_info->read_callback) (dpy, conn_info->fd, conn_info->call_data);
+ LockDisplay(dpy);
+ dpy->flags &= ~XlibDisplayProcConni;
+}
+
+/* XProcessInternalConnection
+ * Call the _XInternalConnectionProc registered by _XRegisterInternalConnection
+ * for this fd.
+ * The Display is NOT locked during the call.
+ */
+void
+XProcessInternalConnection(
+ Display* dpy,
+ int fd
+)
+{
+ struct _XConnectionInfo *info_list;
+
+ LockDisplay(dpy);
+ for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) {
+ if (info_list->fd == fd) {
+ _XProcessInternalConnection(dpy, info_list);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+}
+
+/* XAddConnectionWatch
+ * Register a callback to be called whenever _XRegisterInternalConnection
+ * or _XUnregisterInternalConnection is called.
+ * Callbacks are called with the Display locked.
+ * If any connections are already registered, the callback is immediately
+ * called for each of them.
+ */
+Status
+XAddConnectionWatch(
+ Display* dpy,
+ XConnectionWatchProc callback,
+ XPointer client_data
+)
+{
+ struct _XConnWatchInfo *new_watcher, **wptr;
+ struct _XConnectionInfo *info_list;
+ XPointer *wd_array;
+
+ LockDisplay(dpy);
+
+ /* allocate new watch data */
+ for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) {
+ wd_array = (XPointer *)Xrealloc((char *)info_list->watch_data,
+ (dpy->watcher_count + 1) *
+ sizeof(XPointer));
+ if (!wd_array) {
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ info_list->watch_data = wd_array;
+ wd_array[dpy->watcher_count] = NULL; /* for cleanliness */
+ }
+
+ new_watcher = (struct _XConnWatchInfo*)Xmalloc(sizeof(struct _XConnWatchInfo));
+ if (!new_watcher) {
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ new_watcher->fn = callback;
+ new_watcher->client_data = client_data;
+ new_watcher->next = NULL;
+
+ /* link new structure onto end of list */
+ for (wptr = &dpy->conn_watchers; *wptr; wptr = &(*wptr)->next)
+ ;
+ *wptr = new_watcher;
+ dpy->watcher_count++;
+
+ /* call new watcher on all currently registered fds */
+ for (info_list=dpy->im_fd_info; info_list; info_list=info_list->next) {
+ (*callback) (dpy, client_data, info_list->fd, True,
+ info_list->watch_data + dpy->watcher_count - 1);
+ }
+
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* XRemoveConnectionWatch
+ * Unregister a callback registered by XAddConnectionWatch.
+ * Both callback and client_data must match what was passed to
+ * XAddConnectionWatch.
+ */
+void
+XRemoveConnectionWatch(
+ Display* dpy,
+ XConnectionWatchProc callback,
+ XPointer client_data
+)
+{
+ struct _XConnWatchInfo *watch;
+ struct _XConnWatchInfo *previous = NULL;
+ struct _XConnectionInfo *conni;
+ int counter = 0;
+
+ LockDisplay(dpy);
+ for (watch=dpy->conn_watchers; watch; watch=watch->next) {
+ if (watch->fn == callback && watch->client_data == client_data) {
+ if (previous)
+ previous->next = watch->next;
+ else
+ dpy->conn_watchers = watch->next;
+ Xfree (watch);
+ dpy->watcher_count--;
+ /* remove our watch_data for each connection */
+ for (conni=dpy->im_fd_info; conni; conni=conni->next) {
+ /* don't bother realloc'ing; these arrays are small anyway */
+ /* overlapping */
+ memmove(conni->watch_data+counter,
+ conni->watch_data+counter+1,
+ dpy->watcher_count - counter);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ previous = watch;
+ counter++;
+ }
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+}
+
+/* end of internal connections support */
+
+/* Cookie jar implementation
+ dpy->cookiejar is a linked list. _XEnq receives the events but leaves
+ them in the normal EQ. _XStoreEvent returns the cookie event (minus
+ data pointer) and adds it to the cookiejar. _XDeq just removes
+ the entry like any other event but resets the data pointer for
+ cookie events (to avoid double-free, the memory is re-used by Xlib).
+
+ _XFetchEventCookie (called from XGetEventData) removes a cookie from the
+ jar. _XFreeEventCookies removes all unclaimed cookies from the jar
+ (called by XNextEvent).
+
+ _XFreeDisplayStructure calls _XFreeEventCookies for each cookie in the
+ normal EQ.
+ */
+
+#include "utlist.h"
+struct stored_event {
+ XGenericEventCookie ev;
+ struct stored_event *prev;
+ struct stored_event *next;
+};
+
+Bool
+_XIsEventCookie(Display *dpy, XEvent *ev)
+{
+ return (ev->xcookie.type == GenericEvent &&
+ dpy->generic_event_vec[ev->xcookie.extension & 0x7F] != NULL);
+}
+
+/**
+ * Free all events in the event list.
+ */
+void
+_XFreeEventCookies(Display *dpy)
+{
+ struct stored_event **head, *e, *tmp;
+
+ if (!dpy->cookiejar)
+ return;
+
+ head = (struct stored_event**)&dpy->cookiejar;
+
+ DL_FOREACH_SAFE(*head, e, tmp) {
+ if (dpy->cookiejar == e)
+ dpy->cookiejar = NULL;
+ XFree(e->ev.data);
+ XFree(e);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * Add an event to the display's event list. This event must be freed on the
+ * next call to XNextEvent().
+ */
+void
+_XStoreEventCookie(Display *dpy, XEvent *event)
+{
+ XGenericEventCookie* cookie = &event->xcookie;
+ struct stored_event **head, *add;
+
+ if (!_XIsEventCookie(dpy, event))
+ return;
+
+ head = (struct stored_event**)(&dpy->cookiejar);
+
+ add = Xmalloc(sizeof(struct stored_event));
+ if (!add) {
+ ESET(ENOMEM);
+ _XIOError(dpy);
+ }
+ add->ev = *cookie;
+ DL_APPEND(*head, add);
+ cookie->data = NULL; /* don't return data yet, must be claimed */
+}
+
+/**
+ * Return the event with the given cookie and remove it from the list.
+ */
+Bool
+_XFetchEventCookie(Display *dpy, XGenericEventCookie* ev)
+{
+ Bool ret = False;
+ struct stored_event **head, *event;
+ head = (struct stored_event**)&dpy->cookiejar;
+
+ if (!_XIsEventCookie(dpy, (XEvent*)ev))
+ return ret;
+
+ DL_FOREACH(*head, event) {
+ if (event->ev.cookie == ev->cookie &&
+ event->ev.extension == ev->extension &&
+ event->ev.evtype == ev->evtype) {
+ *ev = event->ev;
+ DL_DELETE(*head, event);
+ Xfree(event);
+ ret = True;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+Bool
+_XCopyEventCookie(Display *dpy, XGenericEventCookie *in, XGenericEventCookie *out)
+{
+ Bool ret = False;
+ int extension;
+
+ if (!_XIsEventCookie(dpy, (XEvent*)in) || !out)
+ return ret;
+
+ extension = in->extension & 0x7F;
+
+ if (!dpy->generic_event_copy_vec[extension])
+ return ret;
+
+ ret = ((*dpy->generic_event_copy_vec[extension])(dpy, in, out));
+ out->cookie = ret ? ++dpy->next_cookie : 0;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * _XEnq - Place event packets on the display's queue.
+ * note that no squishing of move events in V11, since there
+ * is pointer motion hints....
+ */
+void _XEnq(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ register xEvent *event)
+{
+ register _XQEvent *qelt;
+ int type, extension;
+
+ if ((qelt = dpy->qfree)) {
+ /* If dpy->qfree is non-NULL do this, else malloc a new one. */
+ dpy->qfree = qelt->next;
+ }
+ else if ((qelt =
+ (_XQEvent *) Xmalloc((unsigned)sizeof(_XQEvent))) == NULL) {
+ /* Malloc call failed! */
+ ESET(ENOMEM);
+ _XIOError(dpy);
+ }
+ qelt->next = NULL;
+
+ type = event->u.u.type & 0177;
+ extension = ((xGenericEvent*)event)->extension;
+
+ qelt->event.type = type;
+ /* If an extension has registerd a generic_event_vec handler, then
+ * it can handle event cookies. Otherwise, proceed with the normal
+ * event handlers.
+ *
+ * If the generic_event_vec is called, qelt->event is a event cookie
+ * with the data pointer and the "free" pointer set. Data pointer is
+ * some memory allocated by the extension.
+ */
+ if (type == GenericEvent && dpy->generic_event_vec[extension & 0x7F]) {
+ XGenericEventCookie *cookie = &qelt->event.xcookie;
+ (*dpy->generic_event_vec[extension & 0x7F])(dpy, cookie, event);
+ cookie->cookie = ++dpy->next_cookie;
+
+ qelt->qserial_num = dpy->next_event_serial_num++;
+ if (dpy->tail) dpy->tail->next = qelt;
+ else dpy->head = qelt;
+
+ dpy->tail = qelt;
+ dpy->qlen++;
+ } else if ((*dpy->event_vec[type])(dpy, &qelt->event, event)) {
+ qelt->qserial_num = dpy->next_event_serial_num++;
+ if (dpy->tail) dpy->tail->next = qelt;
+ else dpy->head = qelt;
+
+ dpy->tail = qelt;
+ dpy->qlen++;
+ } else {
+ /* ignored, or stashed away for many-to-one compression */
+ qelt->next = dpy->qfree;
+ dpy->qfree = qelt;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * _XDeq - Remove event packet from the display's queue.
+ */
+void _XDeq(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ register _XQEvent *prev, /* element before qelt */
+ register _XQEvent *qelt) /* element to be unlinked */
+{
+ if (prev) {
+ if ((prev->next = qelt->next) == NULL)
+ dpy->tail = prev;
+ } else {
+ /* no prev, so removing first elt */
+ if ((dpy->head = qelt->next) == NULL)
+ dpy->tail = NULL;
+ }
+ qelt->qserial_num = 0;
+ qelt->next = dpy->qfree;
+ dpy->qfree = qelt;
+ dpy->qlen--;
+
+ if (_XIsEventCookie(dpy, &qelt->event)) {
+ XGenericEventCookie* cookie = &qelt->event.xcookie;
+ /* dpy->qfree is re-used, reset memory to avoid double free on
+ * _XFreeDisplayStructure */
+ cookie->data = NULL;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * EventToWire in separate file in that often not needed.
+ */
+
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+Bool
+_XUnknownWireEvent(
+ register Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */
+ register XEvent *re, /* pointer to where event should be reformatted */
+ register xEvent *event) /* wire protocol event */
+{
+#ifdef notdef
+ (void) fprintf(stderr,
+ "Xlib: unhandled wire event! event number = %d, display = %x\n.",
+ event->u.u.type, dpy);
+#endif
+ return(False);
+}
+
+Bool
+_XUnknownWireEventCookie(
+ Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */
+ XGenericEventCookie *re, /* pointer to where event should be reformatted */
+ xEvent *event) /* wire protocol event */
+{
+#ifdef notdef
+ fprintf(stderr,
+ "Xlib: unhandled wire cookie event! extension number = %d, display = %x\n.",
+ ((xGenericEvent*)event)->extension, dpy);
+#endif
+ return(False);
+}
+
+Bool
+_XUnknownCopyEventCookie(
+ Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */
+ XGenericEventCookie *in, /* source */
+ XGenericEventCookie *out) /* destination */
+{
+#ifdef notdef
+ fprintf(stderr,
+ "Xlib: unhandled cookie event copy! extension number = %d, display = %x\n.",
+ in->extension, dpy);
+#endif
+ return(False);
+}
+
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+Status
+_XUnknownNativeEvent(
+ register Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */
+ register XEvent *re, /* pointer to where event should be reformatted */
+ register xEvent *event) /* wire protocol event */
+{
+#ifdef notdef
+ (void) fprintf(stderr,
+ "Xlib: unhandled native event! event number = %d, display = %x\n.",
+ re->type, dpy);
+#endif
+ return(0);
+}
+/*
+ * reformat a wire event into an XEvent structure of the right type.
+ */
+Bool
+_XWireToEvent(
+ register Display *dpy, /* pointer to display structure */
+ register XEvent *re, /* pointer to where event should be reformatted */
+ register xEvent *event) /* wire protocol event */
+{
+
+ re->type = event->u.u.type & 0x7f;
+ ((XAnyEvent *)re)->serial = _XSetLastRequestRead(dpy,
+ (xGenericReply *)event);
+ ((XAnyEvent *)re)->send_event = ((event->u.u.type & 0x80) != 0);
+ ((XAnyEvent *)re)->display = dpy;
+
+ /* Ignore the leading bit of the event type since it is set when a
+ client sends an event rather than the server. */
+
+ switch (event-> u.u.type & 0177) {
+ case KeyPress:
+ case KeyRelease:
+ {
+ register XKeyEvent *ev = (XKeyEvent*) re;
+ ev->root = event->u.keyButtonPointer.root;
+ ev->window = event->u.keyButtonPointer.event;
+ ev->subwindow = event->u.keyButtonPointer.child;
+ ev->time = event->u.keyButtonPointer.time;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventX);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventY);
+ ev->x_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootX);
+ ev->y_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootY);
+ ev->state = event->u.keyButtonPointer.state;
+ ev->same_screen = event->u.keyButtonPointer.sameScreen;
+ ev->keycode = event->u.u.detail;
+ }
+ break;
+ case ButtonPress:
+ case ButtonRelease:
+ {
+ register XButtonEvent *ev = (XButtonEvent *) re;
+ ev->root = event->u.keyButtonPointer.root;
+ ev->window = event->u.keyButtonPointer.event;
+ ev->subwindow = event->u.keyButtonPointer.child;
+ ev->time = event->u.keyButtonPointer.time;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventX);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventY);
+ ev->x_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootX);
+ ev->y_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootY);
+ ev->state = event->u.keyButtonPointer.state;
+ ev->same_screen = event->u.keyButtonPointer.sameScreen;
+ ev->button = event->u.u.detail;
+ }
+ break;
+ case MotionNotify:
+ {
+ register XMotionEvent *ev = (XMotionEvent *)re;
+ ev->root = event->u.keyButtonPointer.root;
+ ev->window = event->u.keyButtonPointer.event;
+ ev->subwindow = event->u.keyButtonPointer.child;
+ ev->time = event->u.keyButtonPointer.time;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventX);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.eventY);
+ ev->x_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootX);
+ ev->y_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.keyButtonPointer.rootY);
+ ev->state = event->u.keyButtonPointer.state;
+ ev->same_screen = event->u.keyButtonPointer.sameScreen;
+ ev->is_hint = event->u.u.detail;
+ }
+ break;
+ case EnterNotify:
+ case LeaveNotify:
+ {
+ register XCrossingEvent *ev = (XCrossingEvent *) re;
+ ev->root = event->u.enterLeave.root;
+ ev->window = event->u.enterLeave.event;
+ ev->subwindow = event->u.enterLeave.child;
+ ev->time = event->u.enterLeave.time;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.enterLeave.eventX);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.enterLeave.eventY);
+ ev->x_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.enterLeave.rootX);
+ ev->y_root = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.enterLeave.rootY);
+ ev->state = event->u.enterLeave.state;
+ ev->mode = event->u.enterLeave.mode;
+ ev->same_screen = (event->u.enterLeave.flags &
+ ELFlagSameScreen) && True;
+ ev->focus = (event->u.enterLeave.flags &
+ ELFlagFocus) && True;
+ ev->detail = event->u.u.detail;
+ }
+ break;
+ case FocusIn:
+ case FocusOut:
+ {
+ register XFocusChangeEvent *ev = (XFocusChangeEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.focus.window;
+ ev->mode = event->u.focus.mode;
+ ev->detail = event->u.u.detail;
+ }
+ break;
+ case KeymapNotify:
+ {
+ register XKeymapEvent *ev = (XKeymapEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = None;
+ memcpy(&ev->key_vector[1],
+ (char *)((xKeymapEvent *) event)->map,
+ sizeof (((xKeymapEvent *) event)->map));
+ }
+ break;
+ case Expose:
+ {
+ register XExposeEvent *ev = (XExposeEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.expose.window;
+ ev->x = event->u.expose.x;
+ ev->y = event->u.expose.y;
+ ev->width = event->u.expose.width;
+ ev->height = event->u.expose.height;
+ ev->count = event->u.expose.count;
+ }
+ break;
+ case GraphicsExpose:
+ {
+ register XGraphicsExposeEvent *ev =
+ (XGraphicsExposeEvent *) re;
+ ev->drawable = event->u.graphicsExposure.drawable;
+ ev->x = event->u.graphicsExposure.x;
+ ev->y = event->u.graphicsExposure.y;
+ ev->width = event->u.graphicsExposure.width;
+ ev->height = event->u.graphicsExposure.height;
+ ev->count = event->u.graphicsExposure.count;
+ ev->major_code = event->u.graphicsExposure.majorEvent;
+ ev->minor_code = event->u.graphicsExposure.minorEvent;
+ }
+ break;
+ case NoExpose:
+ {
+ register XNoExposeEvent *ev = (XNoExposeEvent *) re;
+ ev->drawable = event->u.noExposure.drawable;
+ ev->major_code = event->u.noExposure.majorEvent;
+ ev->minor_code = event->u.noExposure.minorEvent;
+ }
+ break;
+ case VisibilityNotify:
+ {
+ register XVisibilityEvent *ev = (XVisibilityEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.visibility.window;
+ ev->state = event->u.visibility.state;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CreateNotify:
+ {
+ register XCreateWindowEvent *ev =
+ (XCreateWindowEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.createNotify.window;
+ ev->parent = event->u.createNotify.parent;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.createNotify.x);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.createNotify.y);
+ ev->width = event->u.createNotify.width;
+ ev->height = event->u.createNotify.height;
+ ev->border_width = event->u.createNotify.borderWidth;
+ ev->override_redirect = event->u.createNotify.override;
+ }
+ break;
+ case DestroyNotify:
+ {
+ register XDestroyWindowEvent *ev =
+ (XDestroyWindowEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.destroyNotify.window;
+ ev->event = event->u.destroyNotify.event;
+ }
+ break;
+ case UnmapNotify:
+ {
+ register XUnmapEvent *ev = (XUnmapEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.unmapNotify.window;
+ ev->event = event->u.unmapNotify.event;
+ ev->from_configure = event->u.unmapNotify.fromConfigure;
+ }
+ break;
+ case MapNotify:
+ {
+ register XMapEvent *ev = (XMapEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.mapNotify.window;
+ ev->event = event->u.mapNotify.event;
+ ev->override_redirect = event->u.mapNotify.override;
+ }
+ break;
+ case MapRequest:
+ {
+ register XMapRequestEvent *ev = (XMapRequestEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.mapRequest.window;
+ ev->parent = event->u.mapRequest.parent;
+ }
+ break;
+ case ReparentNotify:
+ {
+ register XReparentEvent *ev = (XReparentEvent *) re;
+ ev->event = event->u.reparent.event;
+ ev->window = event->u.reparent.window;
+ ev->parent = event->u.reparent.parent;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.reparent.x);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.reparent.y);
+ ev->override_redirect = event->u.reparent.override;
+ }
+ break;
+ case ConfigureNotify:
+ {
+ register XConfigureEvent *ev = (XConfigureEvent *) re;
+ ev->event = event->u.configureNotify.event;
+ ev->window = event->u.configureNotify.window;
+ ev->above = event->u.configureNotify.aboveSibling;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.configureNotify.x);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.configureNotify.y);
+ ev->width = event->u.configureNotify.width;
+ ev->height = event->u.configureNotify.height;
+ ev->border_width = event->u.configureNotify.borderWidth;
+ ev->override_redirect = event->u.configureNotify.override;
+ }
+ break;
+ case ConfigureRequest:
+ {
+ register XConfigureRequestEvent *ev =
+ (XConfigureRequestEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.configureRequest.window;
+ ev->parent = event->u.configureRequest.parent;
+ ev->above = event->u.configureRequest.sibling;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.configureRequest.x);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.configureRequest.y);
+ ev->width = event->u.configureRequest.width;
+ ev->height = event->u.configureRequest.height;
+ ev->border_width = event->u.configureRequest.borderWidth;
+ ev->value_mask = event->u.configureRequest.valueMask;
+ ev->detail = event->u.u.detail;
+ }
+ break;
+ case GravityNotify:
+ {
+ register XGravityEvent *ev = (XGravityEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.gravity.window;
+ ev->event = event->u.gravity.event;
+ ev->x = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.gravity.x);
+ ev->y = cvtINT16toInt(event->u.gravity.y);
+ }
+ break;
+ case ResizeRequest:
+ {
+ register XResizeRequestEvent *ev =
+ (XResizeRequestEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.resizeRequest.window;
+ ev->width = event->u.resizeRequest.width;
+ ev->height = event->u.resizeRequest.height;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CirculateNotify:
+ {
+ register XCirculateEvent *ev = (XCirculateEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.circulate.window;
+ ev->event = event->u.circulate.event;
+ ev->place = event->u.circulate.place;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CirculateRequest:
+ {
+ register XCirculateRequestEvent *ev =
+ (XCirculateRequestEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.circulate.window;
+ ev->parent = event->u.circulate.event;
+ ev->place = event->u.circulate.place;
+ }
+ break;
+ case PropertyNotify:
+ {
+ register XPropertyEvent *ev = (XPropertyEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.property.window;
+ ev->atom = event->u.property.atom;
+ ev->time = event->u.property.time;
+ ev->state = event->u.property.state;
+ }
+ break;
+ case SelectionClear:
+ {
+ register XSelectionClearEvent *ev =
+ (XSelectionClearEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.selectionClear.window;
+ ev->selection = event->u.selectionClear.atom;
+ ev->time = event->u.selectionClear.time;
+ }
+ break;
+ case SelectionRequest:
+ {
+ register XSelectionRequestEvent *ev =
+ (XSelectionRequestEvent *) re;
+ ev->owner = event->u.selectionRequest.owner;
+ ev->requestor = event->u.selectionRequest.requestor;
+ ev->selection = event->u.selectionRequest.selection;
+ ev->target = event->u.selectionRequest.target;
+ ev->property = event->u.selectionRequest.property;
+ ev->time = event->u.selectionRequest.time;
+ }
+ break;
+ case SelectionNotify:
+ {
+ register XSelectionEvent *ev = (XSelectionEvent *) re;
+ ev->requestor = event->u.selectionNotify.requestor;
+ ev->selection = event->u.selectionNotify.selection;
+ ev->target = event->u.selectionNotify.target;
+ ev->property = event->u.selectionNotify.property;
+ ev->time = event->u.selectionNotify.time;
+ }
+ break;
+ case ColormapNotify:
+ {
+ register XColormapEvent *ev = (XColormapEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.colormap.window;
+ ev->colormap = event->u.colormap.colormap;
+ ev->new = event->u.colormap.new;
+ ev->state = event->u.colormap.state;
+ }
+ break;
+ case ClientMessage:
+ {
+ register int i;
+ register XClientMessageEvent *ev
+ = (XClientMessageEvent *) re;
+ ev->window = event->u.clientMessage.window;
+ ev->format = event->u.u.detail;
+ switch (ev->format) {
+ case 8:
+ ev->message_type = event->u.clientMessage.u.b.type;
+ for (i = 0; i < 20; i++)
+ ev->data.b[i] = event->u.clientMessage.u.b.bytes[i];
+ break;
+ case 16:
+ ev->message_type = event->u.clientMessage.u.s.type;
+ ev->data.s[0] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts0);
+ ev->data.s[1] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts1);
+ ev->data.s[2] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts2);
+ ev->data.s[3] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts3);
+ ev->data.s[4] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts4);
+ ev->data.s[5] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts5);
+ ev->data.s[6] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts6);
+ ev->data.s[7] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts7);
+ ev->data.s[8] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts8);
+ ev->data.s[9] = cvtINT16toShort(event->u.clientMessage.u.s.shorts9);
+ break;
+ case 32:
+ ev->message_type = event->u.clientMessage.u.l.type;
+ ev->data.l[0] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs0);
+ ev->data.l[1] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs1);
+ ev->data.l[2] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs2);
+ ev->data.l[3] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs3);
+ ev->data.l[4] = cvtINT32toLong(event->u.clientMessage.u.l.longs4);
+ break;
+ default: /* XXX should never occur */
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+ case MappingNotify:
+ {
+ register XMappingEvent *ev = (XMappingEvent *)re;
+ ev->window = 0;
+ ev->first_keycode = event->u.mappingNotify.firstKeyCode;
+ ev->request = event->u.mappingNotify.request;
+ ev->count = event->u.mappingNotify.count;
+ }
+ break;
+ default:
+ return(_XUnknownWireEvent(dpy, re, event));
+ }
+ return(True);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * _XDefaultIOError - Default fatal system error reporting routine. Called
+ * when an X internal system error is encountered.
+ */
+int _XDefaultIOError(
+ Display *dpy)
+{
+ if (ECHECK(EPIPE)) {
+ (void) fprintf (stderr,
+ "X connection to %s broken (explicit kill or server shutdown).\r\n",
+ DisplayString (dpy));
+ } else {
+ (void) fprintf (stderr,
+ "XIO: fatal IO error %d (%s) on X server \"%s\"\r\n",
+#ifdef WIN32
+ WSAGetLastError(), strerror(WSAGetLastError()),
+#else
+ errno, strerror (errno),
+#endif
+ DisplayString (dpy));
+ (void) fprintf (stderr,
+ " after %lu requests (%lu known processed) with %d events remaining.\r\n",
+ NextRequest(dpy) - 1, LastKnownRequestProcessed(dpy),
+ QLength(dpy));
+
+ }
+ exit(1);
+ return(0); /* dummy - function should never return */
+}
+
+
+static int _XPrintDefaultError(
+ Display *dpy,
+ XErrorEvent *event,
+ FILE *fp)
+{
+ char buffer[BUFSIZ];
+ char mesg[BUFSIZ];
+ char number[32];
+ const char *mtype = "XlibMessage";
+ register _XExtension *ext = (_XExtension *)NULL;
+ _XExtension *bext = (_XExtension *)NULL;
+ XGetErrorText(dpy, event->error_code, buffer, BUFSIZ);
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "XError", "X Error", mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ (void) fprintf(fp, "%s: %s\n ", mesg, buffer);
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "MajorCode", "Request Major code %d",
+ mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->request_code);
+ if (event->request_code < 128) {
+ sprintf(number, "%d", event->request_code);
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, "XRequest", number, "", buffer, BUFSIZ);
+ } else {
+ for (ext = dpy->ext_procs;
+ ext && (ext->codes.major_opcode != event->request_code);
+ ext = ext->next)
+ ;
+ if (ext) {
+ strncpy(buffer, ext->name, BUFSIZ);
+ buffer[BUFSIZ - 1] = '\0';
+ } else
+ buffer[0] = '\0';
+ }
+ (void) fprintf(fp, " (%s)\n", buffer);
+ if (event->request_code >= 128) {
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "MinorCode", "Request Minor code %d",
+ mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ fputs(" ", fp);
+ (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->minor_code);
+ if (ext) {
+ sprintf(mesg, "%s.%d", ext->name, event->minor_code);
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, "XRequest", mesg, "", buffer, BUFSIZ);
+ (void) fprintf(fp, " (%s)", buffer);
+ }
+ fputs("\n", fp);
+ }
+ if (event->error_code >= 128) {
+ /* kludge, try to find the extension that caused it */
+ buffer[0] = '\0';
+ for (ext = dpy->ext_procs; ext; ext = ext->next) {
+ if (ext->error_string)
+ (*ext->error_string)(dpy, event->error_code, &ext->codes,
+ buffer, BUFSIZ);
+ if (buffer[0]) {
+ bext = ext;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (ext->codes.first_error &&
+ ext->codes.first_error < (int)event->error_code &&
+ (!bext || ext->codes.first_error > bext->codes.first_error))
+ bext = ext;
+ }
+ if (bext)
+ sprintf(buffer, "%s.%d", bext->name,
+ event->error_code - bext->codes.first_error);
+ else
+ strcpy(buffer, "Value");
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, buffer, "", mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ if (mesg[0]) {
+ fputs(" ", fp);
+ (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->resourceid);
+ fputs("\n", fp);
+ }
+ /* let extensions try to print the values */
+ for (ext = dpy->ext_procs; ext; ext = ext->next) {
+ if (ext->error_values)
+ (*ext->error_values)(dpy, event, fp);
+ }
+ } else if ((event->error_code == BadWindow) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadPixmap) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadCursor) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadFont) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadDrawable) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadColor) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadGC) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadIDChoice) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadValue) ||
+ (event->error_code == BadAtom)) {
+ if (event->error_code == BadValue)
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "Value", "Value 0x%x",
+ mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ else if (event->error_code == BadAtom)
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "AtomID", "AtomID 0x%x",
+ mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ else
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "ResourceID", "ResourceID 0x%x",
+ mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ fputs(" ", fp);
+ (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->resourceid);
+ fputs("\n", fp);
+ }
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "ErrorSerial", "Error Serial #%d",
+ mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ fputs(" ", fp);
+ (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, event->serial);
+ XGetErrorDatabaseText(dpy, mtype, "CurrentSerial", "Current Serial #%d",
+ mesg, BUFSIZ);
+ fputs("\n ", fp);
+ (void) fprintf(fp, mesg, dpy->request);
+ fputs("\n", fp);
+ if (event->error_code == BadImplementation) return 0;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+int _XDefaultError(
+ Display *dpy,
+ XErrorEvent *event)
+{
+ if (_XPrintDefaultError (dpy, event, stderr) == 0) return 0;
+ exit(1);
+ /*NOTREACHED*/
+}
+
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+Bool _XDefaultWireError(Display *display, XErrorEvent *he, xError *we)
+{
+ return True;
+}
+
+/*
+ * _XError - upcall internal or user protocol error handler
+ */
+int _XError (
+ Display *dpy,
+ register xError *rep)
+{
+ /*
+ * X_Error packet encountered! We need to unpack the error before
+ * giving it to the user.
+ */
+ XEvent event; /* make it a large event */
+ register _XAsyncHandler *async, *next;
+
+ event.xerror.serial = _XSetLastRequestRead(dpy, (xGenericReply *)rep);
+
+ for (async = dpy->async_handlers; async; async = next) {
+ next = async->next;
+ if ((*async->handler)(dpy, (xReply *)rep,
+ (char *)rep, SIZEOF(xError), async->data))
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ event.xerror.display = dpy;
+ event.xerror.type = X_Error;
+ event.xerror.resourceid = rep->resourceID;
+ event.xerror.error_code = rep->errorCode;
+ event.xerror.request_code = rep->majorCode;
+ event.xerror.minor_code = rep->minorCode;
+ if (dpy->error_vec &&
+ !(*dpy->error_vec[rep->errorCode])(dpy, &event.xerror, rep))
+ return 0;
+ if (_XErrorFunction != NULL) {
+ int rtn_val;
+#ifdef XTHREADS
+ if (dpy->lock)
+ (*dpy->lock->user_lock_display)(dpy);
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+#endif
+ rtn_val = (*_XErrorFunction)(dpy, (XErrorEvent *)&event); /* upcall */
+#ifdef XTHREADS
+ LockDisplay(dpy);
+ if (dpy->lock)
+ (*dpy->lock->user_unlock_display)(dpy);
+#endif
+ return rtn_val;
+ } else {
+ return _XDefaultError(dpy, (XErrorEvent *)&event);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * _XIOError - call user connection error handler and exit
+ */
+int
+_XIOError (
+ Display *dpy)
+{
+ dpy->flags |= XlibDisplayIOError;
+#ifdef WIN32
+ errno = WSAGetLastError();
+#endif
+
+ /* This assumes that the thread calling exit will call any atexit handlers.
+ * If this does not hold, then an alternate solution would involve
+ * registering an atexit handler to take over the lock, which would only
+ * assume that the same thread calls all the atexit handlers. */
+#ifdef XTHREADS
+ if (dpy->lock)
+ (*dpy->lock->user_lock_display)(dpy);
+#endif
+ UnlockDisplay(dpy);
+
+ if (_XIOErrorFunction != NULL)
+ (*_XIOErrorFunction)(dpy);
+ else
+ _XDefaultIOError(dpy);
+ exit (1);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * This routine can be used to (cheaply) get some memory within a single
+ * Xlib routine for scratch space. A single buffer is reused each time
+ * if possible. To be MT safe, you can only call this between a call to
+ * GetReq* and a call to Data* or _XSend*, or in a context when the thread
+ * is guaranteed to not unlock the display.
+ */
+char *_XAllocScratch(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ unsigned long nbytes)
+{
+ if (nbytes > dpy->scratch_length) {
+ if (dpy->scratch_buffer) Xfree (dpy->scratch_buffer);
+ if ((dpy->scratch_buffer = Xmalloc((unsigned) nbytes)))
+ dpy->scratch_length = nbytes;
+ else dpy->scratch_length = 0;
+ }
+ return (dpy->scratch_buffer);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Scratch space allocator you can call any time, multiple times, and be
+ * MT safe, but you must hand the buffer back with _XFreeTemp.
+ */
+char *_XAllocTemp(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ unsigned long nbytes)
+{
+ char *buf;
+
+ buf = _XAllocScratch(dpy, nbytes);
+ dpy->scratch_buffer = NULL;
+ dpy->scratch_length = 0;
+ return buf;
+}
+
+void _XFreeTemp(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ char *buf,
+ unsigned long nbytes)
+{
+ if (dpy->scratch_buffer)
+ Xfree(dpy->scratch_buffer);
+ dpy->scratch_buffer = buf;
+ dpy->scratch_length = nbytes;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Given a visual id, find the visual structure for this id on this display.
+ */
+Visual *_XVIDtoVisual(
+ Display *dpy,
+ VisualID id)
+{
+ register int i, j, k;
+ register Screen *sp;
+ register Depth *dp;
+ register Visual *vp;
+ for (i = 0; i < dpy->nscreens; i++) {
+ sp = &dpy->screens[i];
+ for (j = 0; j < sp->ndepths; j++) {
+ dp = &sp->depths[j];
+ /* if nvisuals == 0 then visuals will be NULL */
+ for (k = 0; k < dp->nvisuals; k++) {
+ vp = &dp->visuals[k];
+ if (vp->visualid == id) return (vp);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return (NULL);
+}
+
+int
+XFree (void *data)
+{
+ Xfree (data);
+ return 1;
+}
+
+#ifdef _XNEEDBCOPYFUNC
+void _Xbcopy(b1, b2, length)
+ register char *b1, *b2;
+ register length;
+{
+ if (b1 < b2) {
+ b2 += length;
+ b1 += length;
+ while (length--)
+ *--b2 = *--b1;
+ } else {
+ while (length--)
+ *b2++ = *b1++;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifdef DataRoutineIsProcedure
+void Data(
+ Display *dpy,
+ char *data,
+ long len)
+{
+ if (dpy->bufptr + (len) <= dpy->bufmax) {
+ memcpy(dpy->bufptr, data, (int)len);
+ dpy->bufptr += ((len) + 3) & ~3;
+ } else {
+ _XSend(dpy, data, len);
+ }
+}
+#endif /* DataRoutineIsProcedure */
+
+
+#ifdef LONG64
+int
+_XData32(
+ Display *dpy,
+ register long *data,
+ unsigned len)
+{
+ register int *buf;
+ register long i;
+
+ while (len) {
+ buf = (int *)dpy->bufptr;
+ i = dpy->bufmax - (char *)buf;
+ if (!i) {
+ _XFlush(dpy);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (len < i)
+ i = len;
+ dpy->bufptr = (char *)buf + i;
+ len -= i;
+ i >>= 2;
+ while (--i >= 0)
+ *buf++ = *data++;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif /* LONG64 */
+
+#ifdef WORD64
+
+/*
+ * XXX This is a *really* stupid way of doing this. It should just use
+ * dpy->bufptr directly, taking into account where in the word it is.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Data16 - Place 16 bit data in the buffer.
+ *
+ * "dpy" is a pointer to a Display.
+ * "data" is a pointer to the data.
+ * "len" is the length in bytes of the data.
+ */
+
+static doData16(
+ register Display *dpy,
+ short *data,
+ unsigned len,
+ char *packbuffer)
+{
+ long *lp,*lpack;
+ long i, nwords,bits;
+ long mask16 = 0x000000000000ffff;
+
+ lp = (long *)data;
+ lpack = (long *)packbuffer;
+
+/* nwords is the number of 16 bit values to be packed,
+ * the low order 16 bits of each word will be packed
+ * into 64 bit words
+ */
+ nwords = len >> 1;
+ bits = 48;
+
+ for(i=0;i<nwords;i++){
+ if (bits == 48) *lpack = 0;
+ *lpack ^= (*lp & mask16) << bits;
+ bits -= 16 ;
+ lp++;
+ if(bits < 0){
+ lpack++;
+ bits = 48;
+ }
+ }
+ Data(dpy, packbuffer, len);
+}
+
+_XData16 (
+ Display *dpy,
+ short *data,
+ unsigned len)
+{
+ char packbuffer[PACKBUFFERSIZE];
+ unsigned nunits = PACKBUFFERSIZE >> 1;
+
+ for (; len > PACKBUFFERSIZE; len -= PACKBUFFERSIZE, data += nunits) {
+ doData16 (dpy, data, PACKBUFFERSIZE, packbuffer);
+ }
+ if (len) doData16 (dpy, data, len, packbuffer);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Data32 - Place 32 bit data in the buffer.
+ *
+ * "dpy" is a pointer to a Display.
+ * "data" is a pointer to the data.
+ * "len" is the length in bytes of the data.
+ */
+
+static doData32(
+ register Display *dpy
+ long *data,
+ unsigned len,
+ char *packbuffer)
+{
+ long *lp,*lpack;
+ long i,bits,nwords;
+ long mask32 = 0x00000000ffffffff;
+
+ lpack = (long *) packbuffer;
+ lp = data;
+
+/* nwords is the number of 32 bit values to be packed
+ * the low order 32 bits of each word will be packed
+ * into 64 bit words
+ */
+ nwords = len >> 2;
+ bits = 32;
+
+ for(i=0;i<nwords;i++){
+ if (bits == 32) *lpack = 0;
+ *lpack ^= (*lp & mask32) << bits;
+ bits = bits ^32;
+ lp++;
+ if(bits)
+ lpack++;
+ }
+ Data(dpy, packbuffer, len);
+}
+
+void _XData32(
+ Display *dpy,
+ long *data,
+ unsigned len)
+{
+ char packbuffer[PACKBUFFERSIZE];
+ unsigned nunits = PACKBUFFERSIZE >> 2;
+
+ for (; len > PACKBUFFERSIZE; len -= PACKBUFFERSIZE, data += nunits) {
+ doData32 (dpy, data, PACKBUFFERSIZE, packbuffer);
+ }
+ if (len) doData32 (dpy, data, len, packbuffer);
+}
+
+#endif /* WORD64 */
+
+
+/* Make sure this produces the same string as DefineLocal/DefineSelf in xdm.
+ * Otherwise, Xau will not be able to find your cookies in the Xauthority file.
+ *
+ * Note: POSIX says that the ``nodename'' member of utsname does _not_ have
+ * to have sufficient information for interfacing to the network,
+ * and so, you may be better off using gethostname (if it exists).
+ */
+
+#if (defined(_POSIX_SOURCE) && !defined(AIXV3) && !defined(__QNX__)) || defined(hpux) || defined(SVR4)
+#define NEED_UTSNAME
+#include <sys/utsname.h>
+#else
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+#include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * _XGetHostname - similar to gethostname but allows special processing.
+ */
+int _XGetHostname (
+ char *buf,
+ int maxlen)
+{
+ int len;
+
+#ifdef NEED_UTSNAME
+ struct utsname name;
+
+ if (maxlen <= 0 || buf == NULL)
+ return 0;
+
+ uname (&name);
+ len = strlen (name.nodename);
+ if (len >= maxlen) len = maxlen - 1;
+ strncpy (buf, name.nodename, len);
+ buf[len] = '\0';
+#else
+ if (maxlen <= 0 || buf == NULL)
+ return 0;
+
+ buf[0] = '\0';
+ (void) gethostname (buf, maxlen);
+ buf [maxlen - 1] = '\0';
+ len = strlen(buf);
+#endif /* NEED_UTSNAME */
+ return len;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * _XScreenOfWindow - get the Screen of a given window
+ */
+
+Screen *_XScreenOfWindow(Display *dpy, Window w)
+{
+ register int i;
+ Window root;
+ int x, y; /* dummy variables */
+ unsigned int width, height, bw, depth; /* dummy variables */
+
+ if (XGetGeometry (dpy, w, &root, &x, &y, &width, &height,
+ &bw, &depth) == False) {
+ return NULL;
+ }
+ for (i = 0; i < ScreenCount (dpy); i++) { /* find root from list */
+ if (root == RootWindow (dpy, i)) {
+ return ScreenOfDisplay (dpy, i);
+ }
+ }
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+
+#if defined(WIN32)
+
+/*
+ * These functions are intended to be used internally to Xlib only.
+ * These functions will always prefix the path with a DOS drive in the
+ * form "<drive-letter>:". As such, these functions are only suitable
+ * for use by Xlib function that supply a root-based path to some
+ * particular file, e.g. <ProjectRoot>/lib/X11/locale/locale.dir will
+ * be converted to "C:/usr/X11R6.3/lib/X11/locale/locale.dir".
+ */
+
+static int access_file (path, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)
+ char* path;
+ char* pathbuf;
+ int len_pathbuf;
+ char** pathret;
+{
+ if (access (path, F_OK) == 0) {
+ if (strlen (path) < len_pathbuf)
+ *pathret = pathbuf;
+ else
+ *pathret = Xmalloc (strlen (path) + 1);
+ if (*pathret) {
+ strcpy (*pathret, path);
+ return 1;
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int AccessFile (path, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)
+ char* path;
+ char* pathbuf;
+ int len_pathbuf;
+ char** pathret;
+{
+ unsigned long drives;
+ int i, len;
+ char* drive;
+ char buf[MAX_PATH];
+ char* bufp;
+
+ /* just try the "raw" name first and see if it works */
+ if (access_file (path, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret))
+ return 1;
+
+ /* try the places set in the environment */
+ drive = getenv ("_XBASEDRIVE");
+#ifdef __UNIXOS2__
+ if (!drive)
+ drive = getenv ("X11ROOT");
+#endif
+ if (!drive)
+ drive = "C:";
+ len = strlen (drive) + strlen (path);
+ if (len < MAX_PATH) bufp = buf;
+ else bufp = Xmalloc (len + 1);
+ strcpy (bufp, drive);
+ strcat (bufp, path);
+ if (access_file (bufp, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)) {
+ if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp);
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+#ifndef __UNIXOS2__
+ /* one last place to look */
+ drive = getenv ("HOMEDRIVE");
+ if (drive) {
+ len = strlen (drive) + strlen (path);
+ if (len < MAX_PATH) bufp = buf;
+ else bufp = Xmalloc (len + 1);
+ strcpy (bufp, drive);
+ strcat (bufp, path);
+ if (access_file (bufp, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)) {
+ if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp);
+ return 1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* tried everywhere else, go fishing */
+#define C_DRIVE ('C' - 'A')
+#define Z_DRIVE ('Z' - 'A')
+ /* does OS/2 (with or with gcc-emx) have getdrives? */
+ drives = _getdrives ();
+ for (i = C_DRIVE; i <= Z_DRIVE; i++) { /* don't check on A: or B: */
+ if ((1 << i) & drives) {
+ len = 2 + strlen (path);
+ if (len < MAX_PATH) bufp = buf;
+ else bufp = Xmalloc (len + 1);
+ *bufp = 'A' + i;
+ *(bufp + 1) = ':';
+ *(bufp + 2) = '\0';
+ strcat (bufp, path);
+ if (access_file (bufp, pathbuf, len_pathbuf, pathret)) {
+ if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp);
+ return 1;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int _XOpenFile(path, flags)
+ _Xconst char* path;
+ int flags;
+{
+ char buf[MAX_PATH];
+ char* bufp = NULL;
+ int ret = -1;
+ UINT olderror = SetErrorMode (SEM_FAILCRITICALERRORS);
+
+ if (AccessFile (path, buf, MAX_PATH, &bufp))
+ ret = open (bufp, flags);
+
+ (void) SetErrorMode (olderror);
+
+ if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp);
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+int _XOpenFileMode(path, flags, mode)
+ _Xconst char* path;
+ int flags;
+ mode_t mode;
+{
+ char buf[MAX_PATH];
+ char* bufp = NULL;
+ int ret = -1;
+ UINT olderror = SetErrorMode (SEM_FAILCRITICALERRORS);
+
+ if (AccessFile (path, buf, MAX_PATH, &bufp))
+ ret = open (bufp, flags, mode);
+
+ (void) SetErrorMode (olderror);
+
+ if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp);
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+void* _XFopenFile(path, mode)
+ _Xconst char* path;
+ _Xconst char* mode;
+{
+ char buf[MAX_PATH];
+ char* bufp = NULL;
+ void* ret = NULL;
+ UINT olderror = SetErrorMode (SEM_FAILCRITICALERRORS);
+
+ if (AccessFile (path, buf, MAX_PATH, &bufp))
+ ret = fopen (bufp, mode);
+
+ (void) SetErrorMode (olderror);
+
+ if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp);
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+int _XAccessFile(path)
+ _Xconst char* path;
+{
+ char buf[MAX_PATH];
+ char* bufp;
+ int ret = -1;
+ UINT olderror = SetErrorMode (SEM_FAILCRITICALERRORS);
+
+ ret = AccessFile (path, buf, MAX_PATH, &bufp);
+
+ (void) SetErrorMode (olderror);
+
+ if (bufp != buf) Xfree (bufp);
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+#endif
+
+#ifdef WIN32
+#undef _Xdebug
+int _Xdebug = 0;
+int *_Xdebug_p = &_Xdebug;
+void (**_XCreateMutex_fn_p)(LockInfoPtr) = &_XCreateMutex_fn;
+void (**_XFreeMutex_fn_p)(LockInfoPtr) = &_XFreeMutex_fn;
+void (**_XLockMutex_fn_p)(LockInfoPtr
+#if defined(XTHREADS_WARN) || defined(XTHREADS_FILE_LINE)
+ , char * /* file */
+ , int /* line */
+#endif
+ ) = &_XLockMutex_fn;
+void (**_XUnlockMutex_fn_p)(LockInfoPtr
+#if defined(XTHREADS_WARN) || defined(XTHREADS_FILE_LINE)
+ , char * /* file */
+ , int /* line */
+#endif
+ ) = &_XUnlockMutex_fn;
+LockInfoPtr *_Xglobal_lock_p = &_Xglobal_lock;
+#endif
diff --git a/mesalib/src/glsl/Makefile b/mesalib/src/glsl/Makefile index 8059bb472..b63307f53 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/glsl/Makefile +++ b/mesalib/src/glsl/Makefile @@ -204,7 +204,7 @@ glcpp/glcpp-parse.c: glcpp/glcpp-parse.y bison -v -o "$@" --defines=glcpp/glcpp-parse.h $<
builtin_compiler: $(GLSL2_OBJECTS) $(OBJECTS) builtin_stubs.o
- $(APP_CXX) $(INCLUDES) $(CFLAGS) $(LDFLAGS) $(OBJECTS) $(GLSL2_OBJECTS) builtin_stubs.o -o $@
+ $(APP_CXX) $(INCLUDES) $(CXXFLAGS) $(LDFLAGS) $(OBJECTS) $(GLSL2_OBJECTS) builtin_stubs.o -o $@
builtin_function.cpp: builtins/profiles/* builtins/ir/* builtins/tools/generate_builtins.py builtins/tools/texture_builtins.py builtin_compiler
@echo Regenerating builtin_function.cpp...
diff --git a/mesalib/src/glsl/ast_to_hir.cpp b/mesalib/src/glsl/ast_to_hir.cpp index b8a812d94..344d76b57 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/glsl/ast_to_hir.cpp +++ b/mesalib/src/glsl/ast_to_hir.cpp @@ -603,7 +603,8 @@ shift_result_type(const struct glsl_type *type_a, */
ir_rvalue *
validate_assignment(struct _mesa_glsl_parse_state *state,
- const glsl_type *lhs_type, ir_rvalue *rhs)
+ const glsl_type *lhs_type, ir_rvalue *rhs,
+ bool is_initializer)
{
/* If there is already some error in the RHS, just return it. Anything
* else will lead to an avalanche of error message back to the user.
@@ -617,12 +618,13 @@ validate_assignment(struct _mesa_glsl_parse_state *state, return rhs;
/* If the array element types are the same and the size of the LHS is zero,
- * the assignment is okay.
+ * the assignment is okay for initializers embedded in variable
+ * declarations.
*
* Note: Whole-array assignments are not permitted in GLSL 1.10, but this
* is handled by ir_dereference::is_lvalue.
*/
- if (lhs_type->is_array() && rhs->type->is_array()
+ if (is_initializer && lhs_type->is_array() && rhs->type->is_array()
&& (lhs_type->element_type() == rhs->type->element_type())
&& (lhs_type->array_size() == 0)) {
return rhs;
@@ -639,7 +641,7 @@ validate_assignment(struct _mesa_glsl_parse_state *state, ir_rvalue *
do_assignment(exec_list *instructions, struct _mesa_glsl_parse_state *state,
- ir_rvalue *lhs, ir_rvalue *rhs,
+ ir_rvalue *lhs, ir_rvalue *rhs, bool is_initializer,
YYLTYPE lhs_loc)
{
void *ctx = state;
@@ -665,7 +667,8 @@ do_assignment(exec_list *instructions, struct _mesa_glsl_parse_state *state, }
}
- ir_rvalue *new_rhs = validate_assignment(state, lhs->type, rhs);
+ ir_rvalue *new_rhs =
+ validate_assignment(state, lhs->type, rhs, is_initializer);
if (new_rhs == NULL) {
_mesa_glsl_error(& lhs_loc, state, "type mismatch");
} else {
@@ -918,7 +921,7 @@ ast_expression::hir(exec_list *instructions, op[0] = this->subexpressions[0]->hir(instructions, state);
op[1] = this->subexpressions[1]->hir(instructions, state);
- result = do_assignment(instructions, state, op[0], op[1],
+ result = do_assignment(instructions, state, op[0], op[1], false,
this->subexpressions[0]->get_location());
error_emitted = result->type->is_error();
type = result->type;
@@ -1245,7 +1248,7 @@ ast_expression::hir(exec_list *instructions, op[0], op[1]);
result = do_assignment(instructions, state,
- op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL), temp_rhs,
+ op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL), temp_rhs, false,
this->subexpressions[0]->get_location());
type = result->type;
error_emitted = (op[0]->type->is_error());
@@ -1271,7 +1274,7 @@ ast_expression::hir(exec_list *instructions, op[0], op[1]);
result = do_assignment(instructions, state,
- op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL), temp_rhs,
+ op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL), temp_rhs, false,
this->subexpressions[0]->get_location());
type = result->type;
error_emitted = type->is_error();
@@ -1287,7 +1290,7 @@ ast_expression::hir(exec_list *instructions, ir_rvalue *temp_rhs = new(ctx) ir_expression(operations[this->oper],
type, op[0], op[1]);
result = do_assignment(instructions, state, op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL),
- temp_rhs,
+ temp_rhs, false,
this->subexpressions[0]->get_location());
error_emitted = op[0]->type->is_error() || op[1]->type->is_error();
break;
@@ -1303,7 +1306,7 @@ ast_expression::hir(exec_list *instructions, ir_rvalue *temp_rhs = new(ctx) ir_expression(operations[this->oper],
type, op[0], op[1]);
result = do_assignment(instructions, state, op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL),
- temp_rhs,
+ temp_rhs, false,
this->subexpressions[0]->get_location());
error_emitted = op[0]->type->is_error() || op[1]->type->is_error();
break;
@@ -1419,7 +1422,7 @@ ast_expression::hir(exec_list *instructions, op[0], op[1]);
result = do_assignment(instructions, state,
- op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL), temp_rhs,
+ op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL), temp_rhs, false,
this->subexpressions[0]->get_location());
type = result->type;
error_emitted = op[0]->type->is_error();
@@ -1448,7 +1451,7 @@ ast_expression::hir(exec_list *instructions, result = get_lvalue_copy(instructions, op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL));
(void)do_assignment(instructions, state,
- op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL), temp_rhs,
+ op[0]->clone(ctx, NULL), temp_rhs, false,
this->subexpressions[0]->get_location());
type = result->type;
@@ -2234,7 +2237,7 @@ process_initializer(ir_variable *var, ast_declaration *decl, */
if (type->qualifier.flags.q.constant
|| type->qualifier.flags.q.uniform) {
- ir_rvalue *new_rhs = validate_assignment(state, var->type, rhs);
+ ir_rvalue *new_rhs = validate_assignment(state, var->type, rhs, true);
if (new_rhs != NULL) {
rhs = new_rhs;
@@ -2276,7 +2279,7 @@ process_initializer(ir_variable *var, ast_declaration *decl, const glsl_type *initializer_type;
if (!type->qualifier.flags.q.uniform) {
result = do_assignment(initializer_instructions, state,
- lhs, rhs,
+ lhs, rhs, true,
type->get_location());
initializer_type = result->type;
} else
diff --git a/mesalib/src/glsl/glsl_symbol_table.cpp b/mesalib/src/glsl/glsl_symbol_table.cpp index 9714384eb..fa6458df5 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/glsl/glsl_symbol_table.cpp +++ b/mesalib/src/glsl/glsl_symbol_table.cpp @@ -1,168 +1,169 @@ -/* -*- c++ -*- */ -/* - * Copyright © 2010 Intel Corporation - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a - * copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), - * to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation - * the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, - * and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice (including the next - * paragraph) shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR - * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, - * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL - * THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER - * LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING - * FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER - * DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include "glsl_symbol_table.h" - -class symbol_table_entry { -public: - /* Callers of this ralloc-based new need not call delete. It's - * easier to just ralloc_free 'ctx' (or any of its ancestors). */ - static void* operator new(size_t size, void *ctx) - { - void *entry = ralloc_size(ctx, size); - assert(entry != NULL); - return entry; - } - - /* If the user *does* call delete, that's OK, we will just ralloc_free. */ - static void operator delete(void *entry, void *ctx) - { - ralloc_free(entry); - } - static void operator delete(void *entry) - { - ralloc_free(entry); - } - - symbol_table_entry(ir_variable *v) : v(v), f(0), t(0) {} - symbol_table_entry(ir_function *f) : v(0), f(f), t(0) {} - symbol_table_entry(const glsl_type *t) : v(0), f(0), t(t) {} - - ir_variable *v; - ir_function *f; - const glsl_type *t; -}; - -glsl_symbol_table::glsl_symbol_table() -{ - this->language_version = 120; - this->table = _mesa_symbol_table_ctor(); - this->mem_ctx = ralloc_context(NULL); -} - -glsl_symbol_table::~glsl_symbol_table() -{ - _mesa_symbol_table_dtor(table); - ralloc_free(mem_ctx); -} - -void glsl_symbol_table::push_scope() -{ - _mesa_symbol_table_push_scope(table); -} - -void glsl_symbol_table::pop_scope() -{ - _mesa_symbol_table_pop_scope(table); -} - -bool glsl_symbol_table::name_declared_this_scope(const char *name) -{ - return _mesa_symbol_table_symbol_scope(table, -1, name) == 0; -} - -bool glsl_symbol_table::add_variable(ir_variable *v) -{ - if (this->language_version == 110) { - /* In 1.10, functions and variables have separate namespaces. */ - symbol_table_entry *existing = get_entry(v->name); - if (name_declared_this_scope(v->name)) { - /* If there's already an existing function (not a constructor!) in - * the current scope, just update the existing entry to include 'v'. - */ - if (existing->v == NULL && existing->t == NULL) { - existing->v = v; - return true; - } - } else { - /* If not declared at this scope, add a new entry. But if an existing - * entry includes a function, propagate that to this block - otherwise - * the new variable declaration would shadow the function. - */ - symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(v); - if (existing != NULL) - entry->f = existing->f; - int added = _mesa_symbol_table_add_symbol(table, -1, v->name, entry); - assert(added == 0); - (void)added; - return true; - } - return false; - } - - /* 1.20+ rules: */ - symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(v); - return _mesa_symbol_table_add_symbol(table, -1, v->name, entry) == 0; -} - -bool glsl_symbol_table::add_type(const char *name, const glsl_type *t) -{ - symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(t); - return _mesa_symbol_table_add_symbol(table, -1, name, entry) == 0; -} - -bool glsl_symbol_table::add_function(ir_function *f) -{ - if (this->language_version == 110 && name_declared_this_scope(f->name)) { - /* In 1.10, functions and variables have separate namespaces. */ - symbol_table_entry *existing = get_entry(f->name); - if ((existing->f == NULL) && (existing->t == NULL)) { - existing->f = f; - return true; - } - } - symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(f); - return _mesa_symbol_table_add_symbol(table, -1, f->name, entry) == 0; -} - -void glsl_symbol_table::add_global_function(ir_function *f) -{ - symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(f); - int added = _mesa_symbol_table_add_global_symbol(table, -1, f->name, entry); - assert(added == 0); -} - -ir_variable *glsl_symbol_table::get_variable(const char *name) -{ - symbol_table_entry *entry = get_entry(name); - return entry != NULL ? entry->v : NULL; -} - -const glsl_type *glsl_symbol_table::get_type(const char *name) -{ - symbol_table_entry *entry = get_entry(name); - return entry != NULL ? entry->t : NULL; -} - -ir_function *glsl_symbol_table::get_function(const char *name) -{ - symbol_table_entry *entry = get_entry(name); - return entry != NULL ? entry->f : NULL; -} - -symbol_table_entry *glsl_symbol_table::get_entry(const char *name) -{ - return (symbol_table_entry *) - _mesa_symbol_table_find_symbol(table, -1, name); -} +/* -*- c++ -*- */
+/*
+ * Copyright © 2010 Intel Corporation
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a
+ * copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"),
+ * to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation
+ * the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense,
+ * and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the
+ * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice (including the next
+ * paragraph) shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the
+ * Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
+ * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
+ * THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
+ * LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
+ * FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER
+ * DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ */
+
+#include "glsl_symbol_table.h"
+
+class symbol_table_entry {
+public:
+ /* Callers of this ralloc-based new need not call delete. It's
+ * easier to just ralloc_free 'ctx' (or any of its ancestors). */
+ static void* operator new(size_t size, void *ctx)
+ {
+ void *entry = ralloc_size(ctx, size);
+ assert(entry != NULL);
+ return entry;
+ }
+
+ /* If the user *does* call delete, that's OK, we will just ralloc_free. */
+ static void operator delete(void *entry, void *ctx)
+ {
+ ralloc_free(entry);
+ }
+ static void operator delete(void *entry)
+ {
+ ralloc_free(entry);
+ }
+
+ symbol_table_entry(ir_variable *v) : v(v), f(0), t(0) {}
+ symbol_table_entry(ir_function *f) : v(0), f(f), t(0) {}
+ symbol_table_entry(const glsl_type *t) : v(0), f(0), t(t) {}
+
+ ir_variable *v;
+ ir_function *f;
+ const glsl_type *t;
+};
+
+glsl_symbol_table::glsl_symbol_table()
+{
+ this->language_version = 120;
+ this->table = _mesa_symbol_table_ctor();
+ this->mem_ctx = ralloc_context(NULL);
+}
+
+glsl_symbol_table::~glsl_symbol_table()
+{
+ _mesa_symbol_table_dtor(table);
+ ralloc_free(mem_ctx);
+}
+
+void glsl_symbol_table::push_scope()
+{
+ _mesa_symbol_table_push_scope(table);
+}
+
+void glsl_symbol_table::pop_scope()
+{
+ _mesa_symbol_table_pop_scope(table);
+}
+
+bool glsl_symbol_table::name_declared_this_scope(const char *name)
+{
+ return _mesa_symbol_table_symbol_scope(table, -1, name) == 0;
+}
+
+bool glsl_symbol_table::add_variable(ir_variable *v)
+{
+ if (this->language_version == 110) {
+ /* In 1.10, functions and variables have separate namespaces. */
+ symbol_table_entry *existing = get_entry(v->name);
+ if (name_declared_this_scope(v->name)) {
+ /* If there's already an existing function (not a constructor!) in
+ * the current scope, just update the existing entry to include 'v'.
+ */
+ if (existing->v == NULL && existing->t == NULL) {
+ existing->v = v;
+ return true;
+ }
+ } else {
+ /* If not declared at this scope, add a new entry. But if an existing
+ * entry includes a function, propagate that to this block - otherwise
+ * the new variable declaration would shadow the function.
+ */
+ symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(v);
+ if (existing != NULL)
+ entry->f = existing->f;
+ int added = _mesa_symbol_table_add_symbol(table, -1, v->name, entry);
+ assert(added == 0);
+ (void)added;
+ return true;
+ }
+ return false;
+ }
+
+ /* 1.20+ rules: */
+ symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(v);
+ return _mesa_symbol_table_add_symbol(table, -1, v->name, entry) == 0;
+}
+
+bool glsl_symbol_table::add_type(const char *name, const glsl_type *t)
+{
+ symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(t);
+ return _mesa_symbol_table_add_symbol(table, -1, name, entry) == 0;
+}
+
+bool glsl_symbol_table::add_function(ir_function *f)
+{
+ if (this->language_version == 110 && name_declared_this_scope(f->name)) {
+ /* In 1.10, functions and variables have separate namespaces. */
+ symbol_table_entry *existing = get_entry(f->name);
+ if ((existing->f == NULL) && (existing->t == NULL)) {
+ existing->f = f;
+ return true;
+ }
+ }
+ symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(f);
+ return _mesa_symbol_table_add_symbol(table, -1, f->name, entry) == 0;
+}
+
+void glsl_symbol_table::add_global_function(ir_function *f)
+{
+ symbol_table_entry *entry = new(mem_ctx) symbol_table_entry(f);
+ int added = _mesa_symbol_table_add_global_symbol(table, -1, f->name, entry);
+ assert(added == 0);
+ (void)added;
+}
+
+ir_variable *glsl_symbol_table::get_variable(const char *name)
+{
+ symbol_table_entry *entry = get_entry(name);
+ return entry != NULL ? entry->v : NULL;
+}
+
+const glsl_type *glsl_symbol_table::get_type(const char *name)
+{
+ symbol_table_entry *entry = get_entry(name);
+ return entry != NULL ? entry->t : NULL;
+}
+
+ir_function *glsl_symbol_table::get_function(const char *name)
+{
+ symbol_table_entry *entry = get_entry(name);
+ return entry != NULL ? entry->f : NULL;
+}
+
+symbol_table_entry *glsl_symbol_table::get_entry(const char *name)
+{
+ return (symbol_table_entry *)
+ _mesa_symbol_table_find_symbol(table, -1, name);
+}
diff --git a/mesalib/src/glsl/ir.cpp b/mesalib/src/glsl/ir.cpp index ceb989110..7ee07f3c6 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/glsl/ir.cpp +++ b/mesalib/src/glsl/ir.cpp @@ -1157,7 +1157,7 @@ ir_texture::set_sampler(ir_dereference *sampler, const glsl_type *type) this->sampler = sampler;
this->type = type;
- assert(sampler->type->sampler_type == type->base_type);
+ assert(sampler->type->sampler_type == (int) type->base_type);
if (sampler->type->sampler_shadow)
assert(type->vector_elements == 4 || type->vector_elements == 1);
else
diff --git a/mesalib/src/mesa/Makefile b/mesalib/src/mesa/Makefile index 2eb8a18c9..eaba09dcf 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/mesa/Makefile +++ b/mesalib/src/mesa/Makefile @@ -43,7 +43,7 @@ endef define mesa-cxx-c
@mkdir -p $(dir $@)
- $(CXX) -c -o $@ $< $($(1)_CPPFLAGS) $($(1)_CFLAGS) $($(1)_CXXFLAGS)
+ $(CXX) -c -o $@ $< $($(1)_CPPFLAGS) $($(1)_CXXFLAGS)
endef
$(MESA_OBJ_DIR)/%.o: %.c
diff --git a/mesalib/src/mesa/main/extensions.c b/mesalib/src/mesa/main/extensions.c index ea8262086..6de672e92 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/mesa/main/extensions.c +++ b/mesalib/src/mesa/main/extensions.c @@ -56,6 +56,10 @@ struct extension { /** Set of API's in which the extension exists, as a bitset. */
uint8_t api_set;
+
+ /** Year the extension was proposed or approved. Used to sort the
+ * extension string chronologically. */
+ uint16_t year;
};
@@ -73,229 +77,229 @@ struct extension { */
static const struct extension extension_table[] = {
/* ARB Extensions */
- { "GL_ARB_ES2_compatibility", o(ARB_ES2_compatibility), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_blend_func_extended", o(ARB_blend_func_extended), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_copy_buffer", o(ARB_copy_buffer), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_depth_buffer_float", o(ARB_depth_buffer_float), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_depth_clamp", o(ARB_depth_clamp), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_depth_texture", o(ARB_depth_texture), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_draw_buffers", o(ARB_draw_buffers), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_draw_buffers_blend", o(ARB_draw_buffers_blend), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_draw_elements_base_vertex", o(ARB_draw_elements_base_vertex), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_draw_instanced", o(ARB_draw_instanced), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location", o(ARB_explicit_attrib_location), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_fragment_coord_conventions", o(ARB_fragment_coord_conventions), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_fragment_program", o(ARB_fragment_program), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_fragment_program_shadow", o(ARB_fragment_program_shadow), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_fragment_shader", o(ARB_fragment_shader), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_framebuffer_object", o(ARB_framebuffer_object), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_framebuffer_sRGB", o(EXT_framebuffer_sRGB), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_half_float_pixel", o(ARB_half_float_pixel), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_half_float_vertex", o(ARB_half_float_vertex), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_instanced_arrays", o(ARB_instanced_arrays), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_map_buffer_range", o(ARB_map_buffer_range), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_multisample", o(ARB_multisample), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_multitexture", o(ARB_multitexture), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_occlusion_query2", o(ARB_occlusion_query2), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_occlusion_query", o(ARB_occlusion_query), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_pixel_buffer_object", o(EXT_pixel_buffer_object), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_point_parameters", o(EXT_point_parameters), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_point_sprite", o(ARB_point_sprite), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_provoking_vertex", o(EXT_provoking_vertex), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_sampler_objects", o(ARB_sampler_objects), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_seamless_cube_map", o(ARB_seamless_cube_map), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_shader_objects", o(ARB_shader_objects), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_shader_stencil_export", o(ARB_shader_stencil_export), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_shading_language_100", o(ARB_shading_language_100), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_shadow_ambient", o(ARB_shadow_ambient), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_shadow", o(ARB_shadow), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_sync", o(ARB_sync), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_border_clamp", o(ARB_texture_border_clamp), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_buffer_object", o(ARB_texture_buffer_object), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_compression", o(ARB_texture_compression), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_compression_rgtc", o(ARB_texture_compression_rgtc), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_cube_map", o(ARB_texture_cube_map), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_env_add", o(EXT_texture_env_add), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_env_combine", o(ARB_texture_env_combine), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_env_crossbar", o(ARB_texture_env_crossbar), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_env_dot3", o(ARB_texture_env_dot3), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_mirrored_repeat", o(ARB_texture_mirrored_repeat), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_multisample", o(ARB_texture_multisample), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_non_power_of_two", o(ARB_texture_non_power_of_two), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_rectangle", o(NV_texture_rectangle), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_rgb10_a2ui", o(ARB_texture_rgb10_a2ui), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_rg", o(ARB_texture_rg), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_texture_swizzle", o(EXT_texture_swizzle), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_transform_feedback2", o(ARB_transform_feedback2), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_transpose_matrix", o(ARB_transpose_matrix), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_uniform_buffer_object", o(ARB_uniform_buffer_object), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_vertex_array_bgra", o(EXT_vertex_array_bgra), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_vertex_array_object", o(ARB_vertex_array_object), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_vertex_buffer_object", o(ARB_vertex_buffer_object), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_vertex_program", o(ARB_vertex_program), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_vertex_shader", o(ARB_vertex_shader), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_vertex_type_2_10_10_10_rev", o(ARB_vertex_type_2_10_10_10_rev), GL },
- { "GL_ARB_window_pos", o(ARB_window_pos), GL },
+ { "GL_ARB_ES2_compatibility", o(ARB_ES2_compatibility), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_blend_func_extended", o(ARB_blend_func_extended), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_copy_buffer", o(ARB_copy_buffer), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_depth_buffer_float", o(ARB_depth_buffer_float), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_depth_clamp", o(ARB_depth_clamp), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_depth_texture", o(ARB_depth_texture), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ARB_draw_buffers", o(ARB_draw_buffers), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ARB_draw_buffers_blend", o(ARB_draw_buffers_blend), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_draw_elements_base_vertex", o(ARB_draw_elements_base_vertex), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_draw_instanced", o(ARB_draw_instanced), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location", o(ARB_explicit_attrib_location), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_fragment_coord_conventions", o(ARB_fragment_coord_conventions), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_fragment_program", o(ARB_fragment_program), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ARB_fragment_program_shadow", o(ARB_fragment_program_shadow), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_fragment_shader", o(ARB_fragment_shader), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ARB_framebuffer_object", o(ARB_framebuffer_object), GL, 2005 },
+ { "GL_ARB_framebuffer_sRGB", o(EXT_framebuffer_sRGB), GL, 1998 },
+ { "GL_ARB_half_float_pixel", o(ARB_half_float_pixel), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_half_float_vertex", o(ARB_half_float_vertex), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_instanced_arrays", o(ARB_instanced_arrays), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_map_buffer_range", o(ARB_map_buffer_range), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_multisample", o(ARB_multisample), GL, 1994 },
+ { "GL_ARB_multitexture", o(ARB_multitexture), GL, 1998 },
+ { "GL_ARB_occlusion_query2", o(ARB_occlusion_query2), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_occlusion_query", o(ARB_occlusion_query), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ARB_pixel_buffer_object", o(EXT_pixel_buffer_object), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_ARB_point_parameters", o(EXT_point_parameters), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_ARB_point_sprite", o(ARB_point_sprite), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_provoking_vertex", o(EXT_provoking_vertex), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_sampler_objects", o(ARB_sampler_objects), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_seamless_cube_map", o(ARB_seamless_cube_map), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_shader_objects", o(ARB_shader_objects), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ARB_shader_stencil_export", o(ARB_shader_stencil_export), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_shading_language_100", o(ARB_shading_language_100), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_shadow_ambient", o(ARB_shadow_ambient), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ARB_shadow", o(ARB_shadow), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ARB_sync", o(ARB_sync), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_border_clamp", o(ARB_texture_border_clamp), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_buffer_object", o(ARB_texture_buffer_object), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_compression", o(ARB_texture_compression), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_compression_rgtc", o(ARB_texture_compression_rgtc), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_cube_map", o(ARB_texture_cube_map), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_env_add", o(EXT_texture_env_add), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_env_combine", o(ARB_texture_env_combine), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_env_crossbar", o(ARB_texture_env_crossbar), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_env_dot3", o(ARB_texture_env_dot3), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_mirrored_repeat", o(ARB_texture_mirrored_repeat), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_multisample", o(ARB_texture_multisample), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_non_power_of_two", o(ARB_texture_non_power_of_two), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_rectangle", o(NV_texture_rectangle), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_rgb10_a2ui", o(ARB_texture_rgb10_a2ui), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_rg", o(ARB_texture_rg), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_texture_swizzle", o(EXT_texture_swizzle), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_transform_feedback2", o(ARB_transform_feedback2), GL, 2010 },
+ { "GL_ARB_transpose_matrix", o(ARB_transpose_matrix), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_ARB_uniform_buffer_object", o(ARB_uniform_buffer_object), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ARB_vertex_array_bgra", o(EXT_vertex_array_bgra), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_ARB_vertex_array_object", o(ARB_vertex_array_object), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_ARB_vertex_buffer_object", o(ARB_vertex_buffer_object), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ARB_vertex_program", o(ARB_vertex_program), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ARB_vertex_shader", o(ARB_vertex_shader), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ARB_vertex_type_2_10_10_10_rev", o(ARB_vertex_type_2_10_10_10_rev), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_ARB_window_pos", o(ARB_window_pos), GL, 2001 },
/* EXT extensions */
- { "GL_EXT_abgr", o(EXT_abgr), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_bgra", o(EXT_bgra), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_blend_color", o(EXT_blend_color), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_blend_equation_separate", o(EXT_blend_equation_separate), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_blend_func_separate", o(EXT_blend_func_separate), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_blend_logic_op", o(EXT_blend_logic_op), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_blend_minmax", o(EXT_blend_minmax), GL | ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_EXT_blend_subtract", o(EXT_blend_subtract), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_clip_volume_hint", o(EXT_clip_volume_hint), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_compiled_vertex_array", o(EXT_compiled_vertex_array), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_copy_texture", o(EXT_copy_texture), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_depth_bounds_test", o(EXT_depth_bounds_test), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_draw_buffers2", o(EXT_draw_buffers2), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_draw_instanced", o(ARB_draw_instanced), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_draw_range_elements", o(EXT_draw_range_elements), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_fog_coord", o(EXT_fog_coord), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_framebuffer_blit", o(EXT_framebuffer_blit), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_framebuffer_multisample", o(EXT_framebuffer_multisample), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_framebuffer_object", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_framebuffer_sRGB", o(EXT_framebuffer_sRGB), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_gpu_program_parameters", o(EXT_gpu_program_parameters), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_gpu_shader4", o(EXT_gpu_shader4), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_multi_draw_arrays", o(EXT_multi_draw_arrays), GL | ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_EXT_packed_depth_stencil", o(EXT_packed_depth_stencil), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_packed_float", o(EXT_packed_float), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_packed_pixels", o(EXT_packed_pixels), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_paletted_texture", o(EXT_paletted_texture), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_pixel_buffer_object", o(EXT_pixel_buffer_object), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_point_parameters", o(EXT_point_parameters), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_polygon_offset", o(EXT_polygon_offset), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_provoking_vertex", o(EXT_provoking_vertex), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_rescale_normal", o(EXT_rescale_normal), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_secondary_color", o(EXT_secondary_color), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_separate_shader_objects", o(EXT_separate_shader_objects), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_separate_specular_color", o(EXT_separate_specular_color), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_shadow_funcs", o(EXT_shadow_funcs), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_shared_texture_palette", o(EXT_shared_texture_palette), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_stencil_two_side", o(EXT_stencil_two_side), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_stencil_wrap", o(EXT_stencil_wrap), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_subtexture", o(EXT_subtexture), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture3D", o(EXT_texture3D), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_array", o(EXT_texture_array), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_compression_dxt1", o(EXT_texture_compression_s3tc), GL | ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_compression_latc", o(EXT_texture_compression_latc), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_compression_rgtc", o(ARB_texture_compression_rgtc), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_compression_s3tc", o(EXT_texture_compression_s3tc), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_cube_map", o(ARB_texture_cube_map), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_edge_clamp", o(SGIS_texture_edge_clamp), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_env_add", o(EXT_texture_env_add), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_env_combine", o(EXT_texture_env_combine), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_env_dot3", o(EXT_texture_env_dot3), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_filter_anisotropic", o(EXT_texture_filter_anisotropic), GL | ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_format_BGRA8888", o(EXT_texture_format_BGRA8888), ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_integer", o(EXT_texture_integer), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_lod_bias", o(EXT_texture_lod_bias), GL | ES1 },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_mirror_clamp", o(EXT_texture_mirror_clamp), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_object", o(EXT_texture_object), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture", o(EXT_texture), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_rectangle", o(NV_texture_rectangle), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_shared_exponent", o(EXT_texture_shared_exponent), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_sRGB", o(EXT_texture_sRGB), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_sRGB_decode", o(EXT_texture_sRGB_decode), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_swizzle", o(EXT_texture_swizzle), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_texture_type_2_10_10_10_REV", o(dummy_true), ES2 },
- { "GL_EXT_timer_query", o(EXT_timer_query), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_transform_feedback", o(EXT_transform_feedback), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_vertex_array_bgra", o(EXT_vertex_array_bgra), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_vertex_array", o(EXT_vertex_array), GL },
- { "GL_EXT_vertex_array_set", o(EXT_vertex_array_set), GL },
+ { "GL_EXT_abgr", o(EXT_abgr), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_bgra", o(EXT_bgra), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_blend_color", o(EXT_blend_color), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_blend_equation_separate", o(EXT_blend_equation_separate), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_EXT_blend_func_separate", o(EXT_blend_func_separate), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_EXT_blend_logic_op", o(EXT_blend_logic_op), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_blend_minmax", o(EXT_blend_minmax), GL | ES1 | ES2, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_blend_subtract", o(EXT_blend_subtract), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_clip_volume_hint", o(EXT_clip_volume_hint), GL, 1996 },
+ { "GL_EXT_compiled_vertex_array", o(EXT_compiled_vertex_array), GL, 1996 },
+ { "GL_EXT_copy_texture", o(EXT_copy_texture), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_depth_bounds_test", o(EXT_depth_bounds_test), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_EXT_draw_buffers2", o(EXT_draw_buffers2), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_draw_instanced", o(ARB_draw_instanced), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_draw_range_elements", o(EXT_draw_range_elements), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_EXT_fog_coord", o(EXT_fog_coord), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_EXT_framebuffer_blit", o(EXT_framebuffer_blit), GL, 2005 },
+ { "GL_EXT_framebuffer_multisample", o(EXT_framebuffer_multisample), GL, 2005 },
+ { "GL_EXT_framebuffer_object", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_EXT_framebuffer_sRGB", o(EXT_framebuffer_sRGB), GL, 1998 },
+ { "GL_EXT_gpu_program_parameters", o(EXT_gpu_program_parameters), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_gpu_shader4", o(EXT_gpu_shader4), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_multi_draw_arrays", o(EXT_multi_draw_arrays), GL | ES1 | ES2, 1999 },
+ { "GL_EXT_packed_depth_stencil", o(EXT_packed_depth_stencil), GL, 2005 },
+ { "GL_EXT_packed_float", o(EXT_packed_float), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_EXT_packed_pixels", o(EXT_packed_pixels), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_EXT_paletted_texture", o(EXT_paletted_texture), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_pixel_buffer_object", o(EXT_pixel_buffer_object), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_EXT_point_parameters", o(EXT_point_parameters), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_EXT_polygon_offset", o(EXT_polygon_offset), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_provoking_vertex", o(EXT_provoking_vertex), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_EXT_rescale_normal", o(EXT_rescale_normal), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_EXT_secondary_color", o(EXT_secondary_color), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_EXT_separate_shader_objects", o(EXT_separate_shader_objects), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_EXT_separate_specular_color", o(EXT_separate_specular_color), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_EXT_shadow_funcs", o(EXT_shadow_funcs), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_EXT_shared_texture_palette", o(EXT_shared_texture_palette), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_EXT_stencil_two_side", o(EXT_stencil_two_side), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_EXT_stencil_wrap", o(EXT_stencil_wrap), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_EXT_subtexture", o(EXT_subtexture), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture3D", o(EXT_texture3D), GL, 1996 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_array", o(EXT_texture_array), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_compression_dxt1", o(EXT_texture_compression_s3tc), GL | ES1 | ES2, 2004 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_compression_latc", o(EXT_texture_compression_latc), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_compression_rgtc", o(ARB_texture_compression_rgtc), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_compression_s3tc", o(EXT_texture_compression_s3tc), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_cube_map", o(ARB_texture_cube_map), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_edge_clamp", o(SGIS_texture_edge_clamp), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_env_add", o(EXT_texture_env_add), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_env_combine", o(EXT_texture_env_combine), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_env_dot3", o(EXT_texture_env_dot3), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_filter_anisotropic", o(EXT_texture_filter_anisotropic), GL | ES1 | ES2, 1999 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_format_BGRA8888", o(EXT_texture_format_BGRA8888), ES1 | ES2, 2009 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_integer", o(EXT_texture_integer), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_lod_bias", o(EXT_texture_lod_bias), GL | ES1, 1999 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_mirror_clamp", o(EXT_texture_mirror_clamp), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_object", o(EXT_texture_object), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture", o(EXT_texture), GL, 1996 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_rectangle", o(NV_texture_rectangle), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_shared_exponent", o(EXT_texture_shared_exponent), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_sRGB", o(EXT_texture_sRGB), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_sRGB_decode", o(EXT_texture_sRGB_decode), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_swizzle", o(EXT_texture_swizzle), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_EXT_texture_type_2_10_10_10_REV", o(dummy_true), ES2, 2008 },
+ { "GL_EXT_timer_query", o(EXT_timer_query), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_EXT_transform_feedback", o(EXT_transform_feedback), GL, 2011 },
+ { "GL_EXT_vertex_array_bgra", o(EXT_vertex_array_bgra), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_EXT_vertex_array", o(EXT_vertex_array), GL, 1995 },
+ { "GL_EXT_vertex_array_set", o(EXT_vertex_array_set), GL, 1997 },
/* OES extensions */
- { "GL_OES_blend_equation_separate", o(EXT_blend_equation_separate), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_blend_func_separate", o(EXT_blend_func_separate), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_blend_subtract", o(EXT_blend_subtract), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_byte_coordinates", o(dummy_true), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_compressed_paletted_texture", o(dummy_false), DISABLE },
- { "GL_OES_depth24", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_depth32", o(dummy_false), DISABLE },
- { "GL_OES_depth_texture", o(ARB_depth_texture), ES2 },
+ { "GL_OES_blend_equation_separate", o(EXT_blend_equation_separate), ES1, 2009 },
+ { "GL_OES_blend_func_separate", o(EXT_blend_func_separate), ES1, 2009 },
+ { "GL_OES_blend_subtract", o(EXT_blend_subtract), ES1, 2009 },
+ { "GL_OES_byte_coordinates", o(dummy_true), ES1, 2002 },
+ { "GL_OES_compressed_paletted_texture", o(dummy_false), DISABLE, 2003 },
+ { "GL_OES_depth24", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 | ES2, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_depth32", o(dummy_false), DISABLE, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_depth_texture", o(ARB_depth_texture), ES2, 2006 },
#if FEATURE_OES_draw_texture
- { "GL_OES_draw_texture", o(OES_draw_texture), ES1 | ES2 },
+ { "GL_OES_draw_texture", o(OES_draw_texture), ES1 | ES2, 2004 },
#endif
#if FEATURE_OES_EGL_image
/* FIXME: Mesa expects GL_OES_EGL_image to be available in OpenGL contexts. */
- { "GL_OES_EGL_image", o(OES_EGL_image), GL | ES1 | ES2 },
-#endif
- { "GL_OES_element_index_uint", o(EXT_vertex_array), ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_fbo_render_mipmap", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_fixed_point", o(dummy_true), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_framebuffer_object", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_mapbuffer", o(ARB_vertex_buffer_object), ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_matrix_get", o(dummy_true), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_packed_depth_stencil", o(EXT_packed_depth_stencil), ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_point_size_array", o(dummy_true), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_point_sprite", o(ARB_point_sprite), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_query_matrix", o(dummy_true), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_read_format", o(OES_read_format), GL | ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_rgb8_rgba8", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_single_precision", o(dummy_true), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_standard_derivatives", o(OES_standard_derivatives), ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_stencil1", o(dummy_false), DISABLE },
- { "GL_OES_stencil4", o(dummy_false), DISABLE },
- { "GL_OES_stencil8", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 | ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_stencil_wrap", o(EXT_stencil_wrap), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_texture_3D", o(EXT_texture3D), ES2 },
- { "GL_OES_texture_cube_map", o(ARB_texture_cube_map), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_texture_env_crossbar", o(ARB_texture_env_crossbar), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_texture_mirrored_repeat", o(ARB_texture_mirrored_repeat), ES1 },
- { "GL_OES_texture_npot", o(ARB_texture_non_power_of_two), ES2 },
+ { "GL_OES_EGL_image", o(OES_EGL_image), GL | ES1 | ES2, 2006 },
+#endif
+ { "GL_OES_element_index_uint", o(EXT_vertex_array), ES1 | ES2, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_fbo_render_mipmap", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 | ES2, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_fixed_point", o(dummy_true), ES1, 2002 },
+ { "GL_OES_framebuffer_object", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_mapbuffer", o(ARB_vertex_buffer_object), ES1 | ES2, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_matrix_get", o(dummy_true), ES1, 2004 },
+ { "GL_OES_packed_depth_stencil", o(EXT_packed_depth_stencil), ES1 | ES2, 2007 },
+ { "GL_OES_point_size_array", o(dummy_true), ES1, 2004 },
+ { "GL_OES_point_sprite", o(ARB_point_sprite), ES1, 2004 },
+ { "GL_OES_query_matrix", o(dummy_true), ES1, 2003 },
+ { "GL_OES_read_format", o(OES_read_format), GL | ES1, 2003 },
+ { "GL_OES_rgb8_rgba8", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 | ES2, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_single_precision", o(dummy_true), ES1, 2003 },
+ { "GL_OES_standard_derivatives", o(OES_standard_derivatives), ES2, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_stencil1", o(dummy_false), DISABLE, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_stencil4", o(dummy_false), DISABLE, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_stencil8", o(EXT_framebuffer_object), ES1 | ES2, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_stencil_wrap", o(EXT_stencil_wrap), ES1, 2002 },
+ { "GL_OES_texture_3D", o(EXT_texture3D), ES2, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_texture_cube_map", o(ARB_texture_cube_map), ES1, 2007 },
+ { "GL_OES_texture_env_crossbar", o(ARB_texture_env_crossbar), ES1, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_texture_mirrored_repeat", o(ARB_texture_mirrored_repeat), ES1, 2005 },
+ { "GL_OES_texture_npot", o(ARB_texture_non_power_of_two), ES2, 2005 },
/* Vendor extensions */
- { "GL_3DFX_texture_compression_FXT1", o(TDFX_texture_compression_FXT1), GL },
- { "GL_AMD_conservative_depth", o(AMD_conservative_depth), GL },
- { "GL_APPLE_client_storage", o(APPLE_client_storage), GL },
- { "GL_APPLE_object_purgeable", o(APPLE_object_purgeable), GL },
- { "GL_APPLE_packed_pixels", o(APPLE_packed_pixels), GL },
- { "GL_APPLE_vertex_array_object", o(APPLE_vertex_array_object), GL },
- { "GL_ATI_blend_equation_separate", o(EXT_blend_equation_separate), GL },
- { "GL_ATI_envmap_bumpmap", o(ATI_envmap_bumpmap), GL },
- { "GL_ATI_fragment_shader", o(ATI_fragment_shader), GL },
- { "GL_ATI_separate_stencil", o(ATI_separate_stencil), GL },
- { "GL_ATI_texture_compression_3dc", o(ATI_texture_compression_3dc), GL },
- { "GL_ATI_texture_env_combine3", o(ATI_texture_env_combine3), GL },
- { "GL_ATI_texture_mirror_once", o(ATI_texture_mirror_once), GL },
- { "GL_IBM_multimode_draw_arrays", o(IBM_multimode_draw_arrays), GL },
- { "GL_IBM_rasterpos_clip", o(IBM_rasterpos_clip), GL },
- { "GL_IBM_texture_mirrored_repeat", o(ARB_texture_mirrored_repeat), GL },
- { "GL_INGR_blend_func_separate", o(EXT_blend_func_separate), GL },
- { "GL_MESA_pack_invert", o(MESA_pack_invert), GL },
- { "GL_MESA_resize_buffers", o(MESA_resize_buffers), GL },
- { "GL_MESA_texture_array", o(MESA_texture_array), GL },
- { "GL_MESA_texture_signed_rgba", o(MESA_texture_signed_rgba), GL },
- { "GL_MESA_window_pos", o(ARB_window_pos), GL },
- { "GL_MESAX_texture_float", o(ARB_texture_float), GL },
- { "GL_MESA_ycbcr_texture", o(MESA_ycbcr_texture), GL },
- { "GL_NV_blend_square", o(NV_blend_square), GL },
- { "GL_NV_conditional_render", o(NV_conditional_render), GL },
- { "GL_NV_depth_clamp", o(ARB_depth_clamp), GL },
- { "GL_NV_fragment_program", o(NV_fragment_program), GL },
- { "GL_NV_fragment_program_option", o(NV_fragment_program_option), GL },
- { "GL_NV_light_max_exponent", o(NV_light_max_exponent), GL },
- { "GL_NV_packed_depth_stencil", o(EXT_packed_depth_stencil), GL },
- { "GL_NV_point_sprite", o(NV_point_sprite), GL },
- { "GL_NV_primitive_restart", o(NV_primitive_restart), GL },
- { "GL_NV_texgen_reflection", o(NV_texgen_reflection), GL },
- { "GL_NV_texture_barrier", o(NV_texture_barrier), GL },
- { "GL_NV_texture_env_combine4", o(NV_texture_env_combine4), GL },
- { "GL_NV_texture_rectangle", o(NV_texture_rectangle), GL },
- { "GL_NV_vertex_program1_1", o(NV_vertex_program1_1), GL },
- { "GL_NV_vertex_program", o(NV_vertex_program), GL },
- { "GL_S3_s3tc", o(S3_s3tc), GL },
- { "GL_SGIS_generate_mipmap", o(SGIS_generate_mipmap), GL },
- { "GL_SGIS_texture_border_clamp", o(ARB_texture_border_clamp), GL },
- { "GL_SGIS_texture_edge_clamp", o(SGIS_texture_edge_clamp), GL },
- { "GL_SGIS_texture_lod", o(SGIS_texture_lod), GL },
- { "GL_SUN_multi_draw_arrays", o(EXT_multi_draw_arrays), GL },
-
- { 0, 0, 0 },
+ { "GL_3DFX_texture_compression_FXT1", o(TDFX_texture_compression_FXT1), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_AMD_conservative_depth", o(AMD_conservative_depth), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_APPLE_client_storage", o(APPLE_client_storage), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_APPLE_object_purgeable", o(APPLE_object_purgeable), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_APPLE_packed_pixels", o(APPLE_packed_pixels), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_APPLE_vertex_array_object", o(APPLE_vertex_array_object), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ATI_blend_equation_separate", o(EXT_blend_equation_separate), GL, 2003 },
+ { "GL_ATI_envmap_bumpmap", o(ATI_envmap_bumpmap), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ATI_fragment_shader", o(ATI_fragment_shader), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_ATI_separate_stencil", o(ATI_separate_stencil), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_ATI_texture_compression_3dc", o(ATI_texture_compression_3dc), GL, 2004 },
+ { "GL_ATI_texture_env_combine3", o(ATI_texture_env_combine3), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_ATI_texture_mirror_once", o(ATI_texture_mirror_once), GL, 2006 },
+ { "GL_IBM_multimode_draw_arrays", o(IBM_multimode_draw_arrays), GL, 1998 },
+ { "GL_IBM_rasterpos_clip", o(IBM_rasterpos_clip), GL, 1996 },
+ { "GL_IBM_texture_mirrored_repeat", o(ARB_texture_mirrored_repeat), GL, 1998 },
+ { "GL_INGR_blend_func_separate", o(EXT_blend_func_separate), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_MESA_pack_invert", o(MESA_pack_invert), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_MESA_resize_buffers", o(MESA_resize_buffers), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_MESA_texture_array", o(MESA_texture_array), GL, 2007 },
+ { "GL_MESA_texture_signed_rgba", o(MESA_texture_signed_rgba), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_MESA_window_pos", o(ARB_window_pos), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_MESAX_texture_float", o(ARB_texture_float), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_MESA_ycbcr_texture", o(MESA_ycbcr_texture), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_NV_blend_square", o(NV_blend_square), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_NV_conditional_render", o(NV_conditional_render), GL, 2008 },
+ { "GL_NV_depth_clamp", o(ARB_depth_clamp), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_NV_fragment_program", o(NV_fragment_program), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_NV_fragment_program_option", o(NV_fragment_program_option), GL, 2005 },
+ { "GL_NV_light_max_exponent", o(NV_light_max_exponent), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_NV_packed_depth_stencil", o(EXT_packed_depth_stencil), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_NV_point_sprite", o(NV_point_sprite), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_NV_primitive_restart", o(NV_primitive_restart), GL, 2002 },
+ { "GL_NV_texgen_reflection", o(NV_texgen_reflection), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_NV_texture_barrier", o(NV_texture_barrier), GL, 2009 },
+ { "GL_NV_texture_env_combine4", o(NV_texture_env_combine4), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_NV_texture_rectangle", o(NV_texture_rectangle), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_NV_vertex_program1_1", o(NV_vertex_program1_1), GL, 2001 },
+ { "GL_NV_vertex_program", o(NV_vertex_program), GL, 2000 },
+ { "GL_S3_s3tc", o(S3_s3tc), GL, 1999 },
+ { "GL_SGIS_generate_mipmap", o(SGIS_generate_mipmap), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_SGIS_texture_border_clamp", o(ARB_texture_border_clamp), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_SGIS_texture_edge_clamp", o(SGIS_texture_edge_clamp), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_SGIS_texture_lod", o(SGIS_texture_lod), GL, 1997 },
+ { "GL_SUN_multi_draw_arrays", o(EXT_multi_draw_arrays), GL, 1999 },
+
+ { 0, 0, 0, 0 },
};
@@ -823,6 +827,34 @@ _mesa_init_extensions( struct gl_context *ctx ) }
+typedef unsigned short extension_index;
+
+
+/**
+ * Compare two entries of the extensions table. Sorts first by year,
+ * then by name.
+ *
+ * Arguments are indices into extension_table.
+ */
+static int
+extension_compare(const void *p1, const void *p2)
+{
+ extension_index i1 = * (const extension_index *) p1;
+ extension_index i2 = * (const extension_index *) p2;
+ const struct extension *e1 = &extension_table[i1];
+ const struct extension *e2 = &extension_table[i2];
+ int res;
+
+ res = (int)e1->year - (int)e2->year;
+
+ if (res == 0) {
+ res = strcmp(e1->name, e2->name);
+ }
+
+ return res;
+}
+
+
/**
* Construct the GL_EXTENSIONS string. Called the first time that
* glGetString(GL_EXTENSIONS) is called.
@@ -834,15 +866,23 @@ _mesa_make_extension_string(struct gl_context *ctx) char *exts = 0;
/* Length of extension string. */
size_t length = 0;
+ /* Number of extensions */
+ unsigned count;
+ /* Indices of the extensions sorted by year */
+ extension_index *extension_indices;
/* String of extra extensions. */
char *extra_extensions = get_extension_override(ctx);
GLboolean *base = (GLboolean *) &ctx->Extensions;
const struct extension *i;
+ unsigned j;
+
/* Compute length of the extension string. */
+ count = 0;
for (i = extension_table; i->name != 0; ++i) {
if (base[i->offset] && (i->api_set & (1 << ctx->API))) {
length += strlen(i->name) + 1; /* +1 for space */
+ ++count;
}
}
if (extra_extensions != NULL)
@@ -854,13 +894,35 @@ _mesa_make_extension_string(struct gl_context *ctx) return NULL;
}
- /* Build the extension string.*/
+ extension_indices = malloc(count * sizeof extension_indices);
+ if (extension_indices == NULL) {
+ free(exts);
+ free(extra_extensions);
+ return NULL;
+ }
+
+ /* Sort extensions in chronological order because certain old applications (e.g.,
+ * Quake3 demo) store the extension list in a static size buffer so chronologically
+ * order ensure that the extensions that such applications expect will fit into
+ * that buffer.
+ */
+ j = 0;
for (i = extension_table; i->name != 0; ++i) {
if (base[i->offset] && (i->api_set & (1 << ctx->API))) {
- strcat(exts, i->name);
- strcat(exts, " ");
+ extension_indices[j++] = i - extension_table;
}
}
+ assert(j == count);
+ qsort(extension_indices, count, sizeof *extension_indices, extension_compare);
+
+ /* Build the extension string.*/
+ for (j = 0; j < count; ++j) {
+ i = &extension_table[extension_indices[j]];
+ assert(base[i->offset] && (i->api_set & (1 << ctx->API)));
+ strcat(exts, i->name);
+ strcat(exts, " ");
+ }
+ free(extension_indices);
if (extra_extensions != 0) {
strcat(exts, extra_extensions);
free(extra_extensions);
diff --git a/mesalib/src/mesa/main/mtypes.h b/mesalib/src/mesa/main/mtypes.h index 51589aaa8..c6678b85c 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/mesa/main/mtypes.h +++ b/mesalib/src/mesa/main/mtypes.h @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ typedef GLuint64 GLbitfield64;
/** Set a single bit */
-#define BITFIELD64_BIT(b) (1ULL << (b))
+#define BITFIELD64_BIT(b) ((GLbitfield64)1 << (b))
/**
diff --git a/mesalib/src/mesa/main/texobj.c b/mesalib/src/mesa/main/texobj.c index c1fc05c44..fa45cfb17 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/mesa/main/texobj.c +++ b/mesalib/src/mesa/main/texobj.c @@ -39,6 +39,7 @@ #include "macros.h"
#include "teximage.h"
#include "texobj.h"
+#include "texstate.h"
#include "mtypes.h"
#include "program/prog_instruction.h"
@@ -1013,11 +1014,9 @@ void GLAPIENTRY _mesa_BindTexture( GLenum target, GLuint texName )
{
GET_CURRENT_CONTEXT(ctx);
- const GLuint unit = ctx->Texture.CurrentUnit;
- struct gl_texture_unit *texUnit = &ctx->Texture.Unit[unit];
- struct gl_texture_object *newTexObj = NULL, *defaultTexObj = NULL;
+ struct gl_texture_unit *texUnit = _mesa_get_current_tex_unit(ctx);
+ struct gl_texture_object *newTexObj = NULL;
GLint targetIndex;
- GLboolean early_out = GL_FALSE;
ASSERT_OUTSIDE_BEGIN_END(ctx);
if (MESA_VERBOSE & (VERBOSE_API|VERBOSE_TEXTURE))
@@ -1030,13 +1029,13 @@ _mesa_BindTexture( GLenum target, GLuint texName ) return;
}
assert(targetIndex < NUM_TEXTURE_TARGETS);
- defaultTexObj = ctx->Shared->DefaultTex[targetIndex];
/*
* Get pointer to new texture object (newTexObj)
*/
if (texName == 0) {
- newTexObj = defaultTexObj;
+ /* Use a default texture object */
+ newTexObj = ctx->Shared->DefaultTex[targetIndex];
}
else {
/* non-default texture object */
@@ -1071,15 +1070,18 @@ _mesa_BindTexture( GLenum target, GLuint texName ) assert(valid_texture_object(newTexObj));
- _glthread_LOCK_MUTEX(ctx->Shared->Mutex);
- if ((ctx->Shared->RefCount == 1)
- && (newTexObj == texUnit->CurrentTex[targetIndex])) {
- early_out = GL_TRUE;
- }
- _glthread_UNLOCK_MUTEX(ctx->Shared->Mutex);
-
- if (early_out) {
- return;
+ /* Check if this texture is only used by this context and is already bound.
+ * If so, just return.
+ */
+ {
+ GLboolean early_out;
+ _glthread_LOCK_MUTEX(ctx->Shared->Mutex);
+ early_out = ((ctx->Shared->RefCount == 1)
+ && (newTexObj == texUnit->CurrentTex[targetIndex]));
+ _glthread_UNLOCK_MUTEX(ctx->Shared->Mutex);
+ if (early_out) {
+ return;
+ }
}
/* flush before changing binding */
diff --git a/mesalib/src/mesa/program/program.c b/mesalib/src/mesa/program/program.c index 6c97787e8..e0bffc7c6 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/mesa/program/program.c +++ b/mesalib/src/mesa/program/program.c @@ -811,7 +811,7 @@ _mesa_combine_programs(struct gl_context *ctx, /* Connect color outputs of fprogA to color inputs of fprogB, via a
* new temporary register.
*/
- if ((progA->OutputsWritten & (1 << FRAG_RESULT_COLOR)) &&
+ if ((progA->OutputsWritten & BITFIELD64_BIT(FRAG_RESULT_COLOR)) &&
(progB_inputsRead & FRAG_BIT_COL0)) {
GLint tempReg = _mesa_find_free_register(usedTemps, MAX_PROGRAM_TEMPS,
firstTemp);
@@ -834,7 +834,7 @@ _mesa_combine_programs(struct gl_context *ctx, /* compute combined program's InputsRead */
inputsB = progB_inputsRead;
- if (progA->OutputsWritten & (1 << FRAG_RESULT_COLOR)) {
+ if (progA->OutputsWritten & BITFIELD64_BIT(FRAG_RESULT_COLOR)) {
inputsB &= ~(1 << FRAG_ATTRIB_COL0);
}
newProg->InputsRead = progA->InputsRead | inputsB;
diff --git a/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_atom_pixeltransfer.c b/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_atom_pixeltransfer.c index 98be6ab75..e0a1cba2b 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_atom_pixeltransfer.c +++ b/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_atom_pixeltransfer.c @@ -187,7 +187,7 @@ get_pixel_transfer_program(struct gl_context *ctx, const struct state_key *key) inst[ic].TexSrcTarget = TEXTURE_2D_INDEX;
ic++;
fp->Base.InputsRead = (1 << FRAG_ATTRIB_TEX0);
- fp->Base.OutputsWritten = (1 << FRAG_RESULT_COLOR);
+ fp->Base.OutputsWritten = BITFIELD64_BIT(FRAG_RESULT_COLOR);
fp->Base.SamplersUsed = 0x1; /* sampler 0 (bit 0) is used */
if (key->scaleAndBias) {
diff --git a/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_cb_drawpixels.c b/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_cb_drawpixels.c index 5c95eddd0..2909d9d95 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_cb_drawpixels.c +++ b/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_cb_drawpixels.c @@ -213,9 +213,9 @@ st_make_drawpix_z_stencil_program(struct st_context *st, p->InputsRead = FRAG_BIT_TEX0 | FRAG_BIT_COL0;
p->OutputsWritten = 0;
if (write_depth)
- p->OutputsWritten |= (1 << FRAG_RESULT_DEPTH);
+ p->OutputsWritten |= BITFIELD64_BIT(FRAG_RESULT_DEPTH);
if (write_stencil)
- p->OutputsWritten |= (1 << FRAG_RESULT_STENCIL);
+ p->OutputsWritten |= BITFIELD64_BIT(FRAG_RESULT_STENCIL);
p->SamplersUsed = 0x1; /* sampler 0 (bit 0) is used */
if (write_stencil)
diff --git a/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_program.c b/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_program.c index e5c26c563..1efc58799 100644 --- a/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_program.c +++ b/mesalib/src/mesa/state_tracker/st_program.c @@ -798,7 +798,7 @@ st_translate_geometry_program(struct st_context *st, * mapping and the semantic information for each output.
*/
for (attr = 0; attr < GEOM_RESULT_MAX; attr++) {
- if (stgp->Base.Base.OutputsWritten & (1 << attr)) {
+ if (stgp->Base.Base.OutputsWritten & BITFIELD64_BIT(attr)) {
GLuint slot;
slot = gs_num_outputs;
diff --git a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/man/xorg.conf.man b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/man/xorg.conf.man index e3fd0eadf..ce0c177bc 100644 --- a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/man/xorg.conf.man +++ b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/man/xorg.conf.man @@ -1,2478 +1,2485 @@ -.\" shorthand for double quote that works everywhere. -.ds q \N'34' -.TH __xconfigfile__ __filemansuffix__ __vendorversion__ -.SH NAME -__xconfigfile__ and __xconfigdir__ \- configuration files for -__xservername__ X server -.SH INTRODUCTION -.B __xservername__ -supports several mechanisms for supplying/obtaining configuration and -run-time parameters: command line options, environment variables, the -__xconfigfile__ and __xconfigdir__ configuration files, auto-detection, -and fallback defaults. When the same information is supplied in more -than one way, the highest precedence mechanism is used. The list of -mechanisms is ordered from highest precedence to lowest. Note that not -all parameters can be supplied via all methods. The available command -line options and environment variables (and some defaults) are -described in the Xserver(__appmansuffix__) and -__xservername__(__appmansuffix__) manual pages. Most configuration file -parameters, with their defaults, are described below. Driver and module -specific configuration parameters are described in the relevant driver -or module manual page. -.SH DESCRIPTION -.B __xservername__ -uses a configuration file called -.I __xconfigfile__ -and files ending in the suffix -.I .conf -from the directory -.I __xconfigdir__ -for its initial setup. -The -.I __xconfigfile__ -configuration file is searched for in the following places when the -server is started as a normal user: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.IR /etc/X11/ <cmdline> -.IR __projectroot__/etc/X11/ <cmdline> -.IB /etc/X11/ $XORGCONFIG -.IB __projectroot__/etc/X11/ $XORGCONFIG -.I /etc/X11/__xconfigfile__ -.I /etc/__xconfigfile__ -.IR __projectroot__/etc/X11/__xconfigfile__. <hostname> -.I __projectroot__/etc/X11/__xconfigfile__ -.IR __projectroot__/lib/X11/__xconfigfile__. <hostname> -.I __projectroot__/lib/X11/__xconfigfile__ -.fi -.RE -.PP -where -.I <cmdline> -is a relative path (with no \(lq..\(rq components) specified with the -.B \-config -command line option, -.B $XORGCONFIG -is the relative path (with no \(lq..\(rq components) specified by that -environment variable, and -.I <hostname> -is the machine's hostname as reported by -.BR gethostname (__libmansuffix__). -.PP -When the __xservername__ server is started by the \(lqroot\(rq user, the config file -search locations are as follows: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -<cmdline> -.IR /etc/X11/ <cmdline> -.IR __projectroot__/etc/X11/ <cmdline> -.B $XORGCONFIG -.IB /etc/X11/ $XORGCONFIG -.IB __projectroot__/etc/X11/ $XORGCONFIG -.I /etc/X11/__xconfigfile__ -.I /etc/__xconfigfile__ -.IR __projectroot__/etc/X11/__xconfigfile__. <hostname> -.I __projectroot__/etc/X11/__xconfigfile__ -.IR __projectroot__/lib/X11/__xconfigfile__. <hostname> -.I __projectroot__/lib/X11/__xconfigfile__ -.fi -.RE -.PP -where -.I <cmdline> -is the path specified with the -.B \-config -command line option (which may be absolute or relative), -.B $XORGCONFIG -is the path specified by that -environment variable (absolute or relative), -.B $HOME -is the path specified by that environment variable (usually the home -directory), and -.I <hostname> -is the machine's hostname as reported by -.BR gethostname (__libmansuffix__). -.PP -Additional configuration files are searched for in the following -directories when the server is started as a normal user: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.IR /etc/X11/ <cmdline> -.IR __sysconfdir__/X11/ <cmdline> -.I /etc/X11/__xconfigdir__ -.I __sysconfdir__/X11/__xconfigdir__ -.fi -.RE -.PP -where -.I <cmdline> -is a relative path (with no \(lq..\(rq components) specified with the -.B \-configdir -command line option. -.PP -When the __xservername__ server is started by the \(lqroot\(rq user, the -config directory search locations are as follows: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -<cmdline> -.IR /etc/X11/ <cmdline> -.IR __sysconfdir__/X11/ <cmdline> -.I /etc/X11/__xconfigdir__ -.I __sysconfdir__/X11/__xconfigdir__ -.fi -.RE -.PP -where -.I <cmdline> -is the path specified with the -.B \-configdir -command line option (which may be absolute or relative). -.PP -Finally, configuration files will also be searched for in directories -reserved for system use. These are to separate configuration files from -the vendor or 3rd party packages from those of local administration. -These files are found in the following directories: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.I /usr/share/X11/__xconfigdir__ -.I __datadir__/X11/__xconfigdir__ -.fi -.RE -.PP -The -.I __xconfigfile__ -and -.I __xconfigdir__ -files are composed of a number of sections which may be present in any order, -or omitted to use default configuration values. -Each section has the form: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.BI "Section \*q" SectionName \*q -.RI " " SectionEntry - ... -.B EndSection -.fi -.RE -.PP -The section names are: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.BR "Files " "File pathnames" -.BR "ServerFlags " "Server flags" -.BR "Module " "Dynamic module loading" -.BR "Extensions " "Extension enabling" -.BR "InputDevice " "Input device description" -.BR "InputClass " "Input class description" -.BR "Device " "Graphics device description" -.BR "VideoAdaptor " "Xv video adaptor description" -.BR "Monitor " "Monitor description" -.BR "Modes " "Video modes descriptions" -.BR "Screen " "Screen configuration" -.BR "ServerLayout " "Overall layout" -.BR "DRI " "DRI\-specific configuration" -.BR "Vendor " "Vendor\-specific configuration" -.fi -.RE -.PP -The following obsolete section names are still recognised for compatibility -purposes. -In new config files, the -.B InputDevice -section should be used instead. -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.BR "Keyboard " "Keyboard configuration" -.BR "Pointer " "Pointer/mouse configuration" -.fi -.RE -.PP -The old -.B XInput -section is no longer recognised. -.PP -The -.B ServerLayout -sections are at the highest level. -They bind together the input and output devices that will be used in a session. -The input devices are described in the -.B InputDevice -sections. -Output devices usually consist of multiple independent components (e.g., -a graphics board and a monitor). -These multiple components are bound together in the -.B Screen -sections, and it is these that are referenced by the -.B ServerLayout -section. -Each -.B Screen -section binds together a graphics board and a monitor. -The graphics boards are described in the -.B Device -sections, and the monitors are described in the -.B Monitor -sections. -.PP -Config file keywords are case\-insensitive, and \(lq_\(rq characters are -ignored. -Most strings (including -.B Option -names) are also case-insensitive, and insensitive to white space and -\(lq_\(rq characters. -.PP -Each config file entry usually takes up a single line in the file. They -consist of a keyword, which is possibly followed by one or more arguments, -with the number and types of the arguments depending on the keyword. -The argument types are: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.BR "Integer " "an integer number in decimal, hex or octal" -.BR "Real " "a floating point number" -.BR "String " "a string enclosed in double quote marks (\*q)" -.fi -.RE -.PP -Note: hex integer values must be prefixed with \(lq0x\(rq, and octal values -with \(lq0\(rq. -.PP -A special keyword called -.B Option -may be used to provide free\-form data to various components of the server. -The -.B Option -keyword takes either one or two string arguments. -The first is the option name, and the optional second argument is the -option value. -Some commonly used option value types include: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.BR "Integer " "an integer number in decimal, hex or octal" -.BR "Real " "a floating point number" -.BR "String " "a sequence of characters" -.BR "Boolean " "a boolean value (see below)" -.BR "Frequency " "a frequency value (see below)" -.fi -.RE -.PP -Note that -.I all -.B Option -values, not just strings, must be enclosed in quotes. -.PP -Boolean options may optionally have a value specified. -When no value is specified, the option's value is -.BR TRUE . -The following boolean option values are recognised as -.BR TRUE : -.PP -.RS 4 -.BR 1 , -.BR on , -.BR true , -.B yes -.RE -.PP -and the following boolean option values are recognised as -.BR FALSE : -.PP -.RS 4 -.BR 0 , -.BR off , -.BR false , -.B no -.RE -.PP -If an option name is prefixed with -.RB \*q No \*q, -then the option value is negated. -.PP -Example: the following option entries are equivalent: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Option \*qAccel\*q \*qOff\*q" -.B "Option \*qNoAccel\*q" -.B "Option \*qNoAccel\*q \*qOn\*q" -.B "Option \*qAccel\*q \*qfalse\*q" -.B "Option \*qAccel\*q \*qno\*q" -.fi -.RE -.PP -Frequency option values consist of a real number that is optionally -followed by one of the following frequency units: -.PP -.RS 4 -.BR Hz , -.BR k , -.BR kHz , -.BR M , -.B MHz -.RE -.PP -When the unit name is omitted, the correct units will be determined from -the value and the expectations of the appropriate range of the value. -It is recommended that the units always be specified when using frequency -option values to avoid any errors in determining the value. -.SH "FILES SECTION" -The -.B Files -section is used to specify some path names required by the server. -Some of these paths can also be set from the command line (see -.BR Xserver (__appmansuffix__) -and -.BR __xservername__ (__appmansuffix__)). -The command line settings override the values specified in the config -file. -The -.B Files -section is optional, as are all of the entries that may appear in it. -.PP -The entries that can appear in this section are: -.TP 7 -.BI "FontPath \*q" path \*q -sets the search path for fonts. -This path is a comma separated list of font path elements which the __xservername__ -server searches for font databases. -Multiple -.B FontPath -entries may be specified, and they will be concatenated to build up the -fontpath used by the server. Font path elements can be absolute -directory paths, catalogue directories or a font server identifier. The -formats of the later two are explained below: -.PP -.RS 7 -Catalogue directories: -.PP -.RS 4 -Catalogue directories can be specified using the prefix \fBcatalogue:\fR -before the directory name. The directory can then be populated with -symlinks pointing to the real font directories, using the following -syntax in the symlink name: -.PP -.RS 4 -.IR <identifier> : [attribute]: pri= <priority> -.RE -.PP -where -.I <identifier> -is an alphanumeric identifier, -.I [attribute] -is an attribute which will be passed to the underlying FPE and -.I <priority> -is a number used to order the fontfile FPEs. Examples: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.I 75dpi:unscaled:pri=20 -> /usr/share/X11/fonts/75dpi -.I gscript:pri=60 -> /usr/share/fonts/default/ghostscript -.I misc:unscaled:pri=10 \-> /usr/share/X11/fonts/misc -.fi -.PP -.RE .RE .RE -.PP -.RS 7 -Font server identifiers: -.PP -.RS 4 -Font server identifiers have the form: -.RS 4 -.PP -.IR <trans> / <hostname> : <port\-number> -.RE -.PP -where -.I <trans> -is the transport type to use to connect to the font server (e.g., -.B unix -for UNIX\-domain sockets or -.B tcp -for a TCP/IP connection), -.I <hostname> -is the hostname of the machine running the font server, and -.I <port\-number> -is the port number that the font server is listening on (usually 7100). -.RE -.PP -When this entry is not specified in the config file, the server falls back -to the compiled\-in default font path, which contains the following -font path elements (which can be set inside a catalogue directory): -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/misc/ -.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/TTF/ -.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/OTF/ -.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/Type1/ -.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/100dpi/ -.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/75dpi/ -.fi -.RE -.PP -Font path elements that are found to be invalid are removed from the -font path when the server starts up. -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "ModulePath \*q" path \*q -sets the search path for loadable __xservername__ server modules. -This path is a comma separated list of directories which the __xservername__ server -searches for loadable modules loading in the order specified. -Multiple -.B ModulePath -entries may be specified, and they will be concatenated to build the -module search path used by the server. The default module path is -.PP -.RS 11 -__modulepath__ -.RE -.\" The LogFile keyword is not currently implemented -.ig -.TP 7 -.BI "LogFile \*q" path \*q -sets the name of the __xservername__ server log file. -The default log file name is -.PP -.RS 11 -.RI __logdir__/__xservername__. <n> .log -.RE -.PP -.RS 7 -where -.I <n> -is the display number for the __xservername__ server. -.. -.TP 7 -.BI "XkbDir \*q" path \*q -sets the base directory for keyboard layout files. The -.B \-xkbdir -command line option can be used to override this. The default directory is -.PP -.RS 11 -__xkbdir__ -.RE -.SH "SERVERFLAGS SECTION" -In addition to options specific to this section (described below), the -.B ServerFlags -section is used to specify some global -__xservername__ server options. -All of the entries in this section are -.BR Options , -although for compatibility purposes some of the old style entries are -still recognised. -Those old style entries are not documented here, and using them is -discouraged. -The -.B ServerFlags -section is optional, as are the entries that may be specified in it. -.PP -.B Options -specified in this section (with the exception of the -.B \*qDefaultServerLayout\*q -.BR Option ) -may be overridden by -.B Options -specified in the active -.B ServerLayout -section. -Options with command line equivalents are overridden when their command -line equivalent is used. -The options recognised by this section are: -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qDefaultServerLayout\*q \*q" layout\-id \*q -This specifies the default -.B ServerLayout -section to use in the absence of the -.B \-layout -command line option. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qNoTrapSignals\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This prevents the __xservername__ server from trapping a range of unexpected fatal -signals and exiting cleanly. -Instead, the __xservername__ server will die and drop core where the fault occurred. -The default behaviour is for the __xservername__ server to exit cleanly, but still drop a -core file. -In general you never want to use this option unless you are debugging an __xservername__ -server problem and know how to deal with the consequences. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qUseSIGIO\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This controls whether the __xservername__ server requests that events from -input devices be reported via a SIGIO signal handler (also known as SIGPOLL -on some platforms), or only reported via the standard select(3) loop. -The default behaviour is platform specific. In general you do not want to -use this option unless you are debugging the __xservername__ server, or -working around a specific bug until it is fixed, and understand the -consequences. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qDontVTSwitch\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This disallows the use of the -.BI Ctrl+Alt+F n -sequence (where -.RI F n -refers to one of the numbered function keys). -That sequence is normally used to switch to another \*qvirtual terminal\*q -on operating systems that have this feature. -When this option is enabled, that key sequence has no special meaning and -is passed to clients. -Default: off. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qDontZap\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This disallows the use of the -.B Terminate_Server -XKB action (usually on Ctrl+Alt+Backspace, depending on XKB options). -This action is normally used to terminate the __xservername__ server. -When this option is enabled, the action has no effect. -Default: off. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qDontZoom\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This disallows the use of the -.B Ctrl+Alt+Keypad\-Plus -and -.B Ctrl+Alt+Keypad\-Minus -sequences. -These sequences allows you to switch between video modes. -When this option is enabled, those key sequences have no special meaning -and are passed to clients. -Default: off. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qDisableVidModeExtension\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This disables the parts of the VidMode extension used by the xvidtune client -that can be used to change the video modes. -Default: the VidMode extension is enabled. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAllowNonLocalXvidtune\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This allows the xvidtune client (and other clients that use the VidMode -extension) to connect from another host. -Default: off. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAllowMouseOpenFail\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This tells the mousedrv(__drivermansuffix__) and vmmouse(__drivermansuffix__) -drivers to not report failure if the mouse device can't be opened/initialised. -It has no effect on the evdev(__drivermansuffix__) or other drivers. -Default: false. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qVTSysReq\*q \*q" boolean \*q -enables the SYSV\-style VT switch sequence for non\-SYSV systems -which support VT switching. -This sequence is -.B Alt\-SysRq -followed by a function key -.RB ( Fn ). -This prevents the __xservername__ server trapping the -keys used for the default VT switch sequence, which means that clients can -access them. -Default: off. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qBlankTime\*q \*q" time \*q -sets the inactivity timeout for the -.B blank -phase of the screensaver. -.I time -is in minutes. -This is equivalent to the __xservername__ server's -.B \-s -flag, and the value can be changed at run\-time with -.BR xset(__appmansuffix__). -Default: 10 minutes. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qStandbyTime\*q \*q" time \*q -sets the inactivity timeout for the -.B standby -phase of DPMS mode. -.I time -is in minutes, and the value can be changed at run\-time with -.BR xset(__appmansuffix__). -Default: 10 minutes. -This is only suitable for VESA DPMS compatible monitors, and may not be -supported by all video drivers. -It is only enabled for screens that have the -.B \*qDPMS\*q -option set (see the MONITOR section below). -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qSuspendTime\*q \*q" time \*q -sets the inactivity timeout for the -.B suspend -phase of DPMS mode. -.I time -is in minutes, and the value can be changed at run\-time with -.BR xset(__appmansuffix__). -Default: 10 minutes. -This is only suitable for VESA DPMS compatible monitors, and may not be -supported by all video drivers. -It is only enabled for screens that have the -.B \*qDPMS\*q -option set (see the MONITOR section below). -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qOffTime\*q \*q" time \*q -sets the inactivity timeout for the -.B off -phase of DPMS mode. -.I time -is in minutes, and the value can be changed at run\-time with -.BR xset(__appmansuffix__). -Default: 10 minutes. -This is only suitable for VESA DPMS compatible monitors, and may not be -supported by all video drivers. -It is only enabled for screens that have the -.B \*qDPMS\*q -option set (see the MONITOR section below). -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qPixmap\*q \*q" bpp \*q -This sets the pixmap format to use for depth 24. -Allowed values for -.I bpp -are 24 and 32. -Default: 32 unless driver constraints don't allow this (which is rare). -Note: some clients don't behave well when this value is set to 24. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qPC98\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Specify that the machine is a Japanese PC\-98 machine. -This should not be enabled for anything other than the Japanese\-specific -PC\-98 architecture. -Default: auto\-detected. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qNoPM\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Disables something to do with power management events. -Default: PM enabled on platforms that support it. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXinerama\*q \*q" boolean \*q -enable or disable XINERAMA extension. -Default is disabled. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAIGLX\*q \*q" boolean \*q -enable or disable AIGLX. AIGLX is enabled by default. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qDRI2\*q \*q" boolean \*q -enable or disable DRI2. DRI2 is disabled by default. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qGlxVisuals\*q \*q" string \*q -This option controls how many GLX visuals the GLX modules sets up. -The default value is -.BR "typical" , -which will setup up a typical subset of -the GLXFBConfigs provided by the driver as GLX visuals. Other options are -.BR "minimal" , -which will set up the minimal set allowed by the GLX specification and -.BR "all" -which will setup GLX visuals for all GLXFBConfigs. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qUseDefaultFontPath\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Include the default font path even if other paths are specified in -xorg.conf. If enabled, other font paths are included as well. Enabled by -default. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qIgnoreABI\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Allow modules built for a different, potentially incompatible version of -the X server to load. Disabled by default. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAutoAddDevices\*q \*q" boolean \*q -If this option is disabled, then no devices will be added from HAL events. -Enabled by default. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAutoEnableDevices\*q \*q" boolean \*q -If this option is disabled, then the devices will be added (and the -DevicePresenceNotify event sent), but not enabled, thus leaving policy up -to the client. -Enabled by default. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qLog\*q \*q" string \*q -This option controls whether the log is flushed and/or synced to disk after -each message. -Possible values are -.B flush -or -.BR sync . -Unset by default. -.SH "MODULE SECTION" -The -.B Module -section is used to specify which __xservername__ server modules should be loaded. -This section is ignored when the __xservername__ server is built in static form. -The type of modules normally loaded in this section are __xservername__ server -extension modules. -Most other module types are loaded automatically when they are needed via -other mechanisms. -The -.B Module -section is optional, as are all of the entries that may be specified in -it. -.PP -Entries in this section may be in two forms. -The first and most commonly used form is an entry that uses the -.B Load -keyword, as described here: -.TP 7 -.BI "Load \*q" modulename \*q -This instructs the server to load the module called -.IR modulename . -The module name given should be the module's standard name, not the -module file name. -The standard name is case\-sensitive, and does not include the \(lqlib\(rq -prefix, or the \(lq.a\(rq, \(lq.o\(rq, or \(lq.so\(rq suffixes. -.PP -.RS 7 -Example: the DRI extension module can be loaded with the following entry: -.PP -.RS 4 -.B "Load \*qdri\*q" -.RE -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "Disable \*q" modulename \*q -This instructs the server to not load the module called -.IR modulename . -Some modules are loaded by default in the server, and this overrides that -default. If a -.B Load -instruction is given for the same module, it overrides the -.B Disable -instruction and the module is loaded. The module name given should be the -module's standard name, not the module file name. As with the -.B Load -instruction, the standard name is case-sensitive, and does not include the -"lib" prefix, or the ".a", ".o", or ".so" suffixes. -.PP -The second form of entry is a -.BR SubSection, -with the subsection name being the module name, and the contents of the -.B SubSection -being -.B Options -that are passed to the module when it is loaded. -.PP -Example: the extmod module (which contains a miscellaneous group of -server extensions) can be loaded, with the XFree86\-DGA extension -disabled by using the following entry: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "SubSection \*qextmod\*q" -.B " Option \*qomit XFree86\-DGA\*q" -.B EndSubSection -.fi -.RE -.PP -Modules are searched for in each directory specified in the -.B ModulePath -search path, and in the drivers, extensions, input, internal, and -multimedia subdirectories of each of those directories. -In addition to this, operating system specific subdirectories of all -the above are searched first if they exist. -.PP -To see what extension modules are available, check the extensions -subdirectory under: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -__modulepath__ -.fi -.RE -.PP -The \(lqextmod\(rq, \(lqdbe\(rq, \(lqdri\(rq, \(lqdri2\(rq, \(lqglx\(rq, -and \(lqrecord\(rq extension modules are loaded automatically, if they -are present, unless disabled with \*qDisable\*q entries. -It is recommended -that at very least the \(lqextmod\(rq extension module be loaded. -If it isn't, some commonly used server extensions (like the SHAPE -extension) will not be available. -.SH "EXTENSIONS SECTION" -The -.B Extensions -section is used to specify which X11 protocol extensions should be enabled -or disabled. -The -.B Extensions -section is optional, as are all of the entries that may be specified in -it. -.PP -Entries in this section are listed as Option statements with the name of -the extension as the first argument, and a boolean value as the second. -The extension name is case\-sensitive, and matches the form shown in the output -of \*qXorg -extension ?\*q. -.PP -.RS 7 -Example: the MIT-SHM extension can be disabled with the following entry: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qExtensions\*q" -.B " Option \*qMIT-SHM\*q \*qDisable\*q" -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.RE -.SH "INPUTDEVICE SECTION" -The config file may have multiple -.B InputDevice -sections. -Recent X servers employ input hotplugging to add input devices, with the HAL -backend being the default backend for X servers since 1.4. It is usually not -necessary to provide -.B InputDevice -sections in the xorg.conf if hotplugging is enabled. -.PP -If hotplugging is disabled, there will normally -be at least two: one for the core (primary) keyboard -and one for the core pointer. -If either of these two is missing, a default configuration for the missing -ones will be used. In the absence of an explicitly specified core input -device, the first -.B InputDevice -marked as -.B CorePointer -(or -.BR CoreKeyboard ) -is used. -If there is no match there, the first -.B InputDevice -that uses the \(lqmouse\(rq (or \(lqkbd\(rq) driver is used. -The final fallback is to use built\-in default configurations. -Currently the default configuration may not work as expected on all platforms. -.PP -.B InputDevice -sections have the following format: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qInputDevice\*q" -.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q -.BI " Driver \*q" inputdriver \*q -.I " options" -.I " ..." -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.PP -The -.B Identifier -and -.B Driver -entries are required in all -.B InputDevice -sections. -All other entries are optional. -.PP -The -.B Identifier -entry specifies the unique name for this input device. -The -.B Driver -entry specifies the name of the driver to use for this input device. -When using the loadable server, the input driver module -.RI \*q inputdriver \*q -will be loaded for each active -.B InputDevice -section. -An -.B InputDevice -section is considered active if it is referenced by an active -.B ServerLayout -section, if it is referenced by the -.B \-keyboard -or -.B \-pointer -command line options, or if it is selected implicitly as the core pointer -or keyboard device in the absence of such explicit references. -The most commonly used input drivers are -.BR evdev (__drivermansuffix__) -on Linux systems, and -.BR kbd (__drivermansuffix__) -and -.BR mousedrv (__drivermansuffix__) -on other platforms. -.PP -.PP -.B InputDevice -sections recognise some driver\-independent -.BR Options , -which are described here. -See the individual input driver manual pages for a description of the -device\-specific options. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAutoServerLayout\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Always add the device to the ServerLayout section used by this instance of -the server. This affects implied layouts as well as explicit layouts -specified in the configuration and/or on the command line. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qCorePointer\*q" -Deprecated, see -.B Floating -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qCoreKeyboard\*q" -Deprecated, see -.B Floating -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAlwaysCore\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Deprecated, see -.B Floating -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qSendCoreEvents\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Deprecated, see -.B Floating - -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qFloating\*q \*q" boolean \*q -When enabled, the input device is set up floating and does not -report events through any master device or control a cursor. The device is -only available to clients using the X Input Extension API. This option is -disabled by default. -The options -.B CorePointer, -.B CoreKeyboard, -.B AlwaysCore, -and -.B SendCoreEvents, -are the inverse of option -.B Floating -(i.e. -.B SendCoreEvents \*qon\*q -is equivalent to -.B Floating \*qoff\*q -). - -This option controls the startup behavior only, a device -may be reattached or set floating at runtime. -.PP -For pointing devices, the following options control how the pointer -is accelerated or decelerated with respect to physical device motion. Most of -these can be adjusted at runtime, see the xinput(1) man page for details. Only -the most important acceleration options are discussed here. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAccelerationProfile\*q \*q" integer \*q -Select the profile. In layman's terms, the profile constitutes the "feeling" of -the acceleration. More formally, it defines how the transfer function (actual -acceleration as a function of current device velocity and acceleration controls) -is constructed. This is mainly a matter of personal preference. -.PP -.RS 6 -.nf -.B " 0 classic (mostly compatible)" -.B "-1 none (only constant deceleration is applied)" -.B " 1 device-dependent" -.B " 2 polynomial (polynomial function)" -.B " 3 smooth linear (soft knee, then linear)" -.B " 4 simple (normal when slow, otherwise accelerated)" -.B " 5 power (power function)" -.B " 6 linear (more speed, more acceleration)" -.B " 7 limited (like linear, but maxes out at threshold)" -.fi -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qConstantDeceleration\*q \*q" real \*q -Makes the pointer go -.B deceleration -times slower than normal. Most useful for high-resolution devices. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAdaptiveDeceleration\*q \*q" real \*q -Allows to actually decelerate the pointer when going slow. At most, it will be -.B adaptive deceleration -times slower. Enables precise pointer placement without sacrificing speed. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAccelerationScheme\*q \*q" string \*q -Selects the scheme, which is the underlying algorithm. -.PP -.RS 7 -.nf -.B "predictable default algorithm (behaving more predictable)" -.B "lightweight old acceleration code (as specified in the X protocol spec)" -.B "none no acceleration or deceleration" -.fi -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAccelerationNumerator\*q \*q" integer \*q -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAccelerationDenominator\*q \*q" integer \*q -Set numerator and denominator of the acceleration factor. The acceleration -factor is a rational which, together with threshold, can be used to tweak -profiles to suit the users needs. The -.B simple -and -.B limited -profiles use it directly (i.e. they accelerate by the factor), for other -profiles it should hold that a higher acceleration factor leads to a faster -pointer. Typically, 1 is unaccelerated and values up to 5 are sensible. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAccelerationThreshold\*q \*q" integer \*q -Set the threshold, which is roughly the velocity (usually device units per 10 -ms) required for acceleration to become effective. The precise effect varies -with the profile however. - -.SH "INPUTCLASS SECTION" -The config file may have multiple -.B InputClass -sections. -These sections are optional and are used to provide configuration for a -class of input devices as they are automatically added. An input device can -match more than one -.B InputClass -section. Each class can override settings from a previous class, so it is -best to arrange the sections with the most generic matches first. -.PP -.B InputClass -sections have the following format: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qInputClass\*q" -.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q -.I " entries" -.I " ..." -.I " options" -.I " ..." -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.PP -The -.B Identifier -entry is required in all -.B InputClass -sections. -All other entries are optional. -.PP -The -.B Identifier -entry specifies the unique name for this input class. -The -.B Driver -entry specifies the name of the driver to use for this input device. -After all classes have been examined, the -.RI \*q inputdriver \*q -module from the first -.B Driver -entry will be enabled when using the loadable server. -.PP -When an input device is automatically added, its characteristics are -checked against all -.B InputClass -sections. Each section can contain optional entries to narrow the match -of the class. If none of the optional entries appear, the -.B InputClass -section is generic and will match any input device. If more than one of -these entries appear, they all must match for the configuration to apply. -.PP -There are two types of match entries used in -.B InputClass -sections. The first allows various tokens to be matched against attributes -of the device. An entry can be constructed to match attributes from different -devices by separating arguments with a '|' character. Multiple entries of the -same type may be supplied to add multiple matching conditions on the same -attribute. For example: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qInputClass\*q" -.B " Identifier \*qMy Class\*q" -.B " # product string must contain example and -.B " # either gizmo or gadget -.B " MatchProduct \*qexample\*q -.B " MatchProduct \*qgizmo|gadget\*q -.I " ..." -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchProduct \*q" matchproduct \*q -This entry can be used to check if the substring -.RI \*q matchproduct \*q -occurs in the device's product name. -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchVendor \*q" matchvendor \*q -This entry can be used to check if the substring -.RI \*q matchvendor \*q -occurs in the device's vendor name. -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchDevicePath \*q" matchdevice \*q -This entry can be used to check if the device file matches the -.RI \*q matchdevice \*q -pathname pattern. -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchOS \*q" matchos \*q -This entry can be used to check if the operating system matches the -case-insensitive -.RI \*q matchos \*q -string. This entry is only supported on platforms providing the -.BR uname (2) -system call. -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchPnPID \*q" matchpnp \*q -The device's Plug and Play (PnP) ID can be checked against the -.RI \*q matchpnp \*q -shell wildcard pattern. -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchUSBID \*q" matchusb \*q -The device's USB ID can be checked against the -.RI \*q matchusb \*q -shell wildcard pattern. The ID is constructed as lowercase hexadecimal numbers -separated by a ':'. This is the same format as the -.BR lsusb (8) -program. -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchDriver \*q" matchdriver \*q -Check the case-sensitive string -.RI \*q matchdriver \*q -against the currently configured driver of the device. Ordering of sections -using this entry is important since it will not match unless the driver has -been set by the config backend or a previous -.B InputClass -section. -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchTag \*q" matchtag \*q -This entry can be used to check if tags assigned by the config backend -matches the -.RI \*q matchtag \*q -pattern. A match is found if at least one of the tags given in -.RI \*q matchtag \*q -matches at least one of the tags assigned by the backend. -.PP -The second type of entry is used to match device types. These entries take a -boolean argument similar to -.B Option -entries. -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchIsKeyboard \*q" bool \*q -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchIsPointer \*q" bool \*q -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchIsJoystick \*q" bool \*q -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchIsTablet \*q" bool \*q -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchIsTouchpad \*q" bool \*q -.TP 7 -.BI "MatchIsTouchscreen \*q" bool \*q -.PP -When an input device has been matched to the -.B InputClass -section, any -.B Option -entries are applied to the device. One -.B InputClass -specific -.B Option -is recognized. See the -.B InputDevice -section above for a description of the remaining -.B Option -entries. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qIgnore\*q \*q" boolean \*q -This optional entry specifies that the device should be ignored entirely, -and not added to the server. This can be useful when the device is handled -by another program and no X events should be generated. -.SH "DEVICE SECTION" -The config file may have multiple -.B Device -sections. -There must be at least one, for the video card being used. -.PP -.B Device -sections have the following format: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qDevice\*q" -.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q -.BI " Driver \*q" driver \*q -.I " entries" -.I " ..." -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.PP -The -.B Identifier -and -.B Driver -entries are required in all -.B Device -sections. All other entries are optional. -.PP -The -.B Identifier -entry specifies the unique name for this graphics device. -The -.B Driver -entry specifies the name of the driver to use for this graphics device. -When using the loadable server, the driver module -.RI \*q driver \*q -will be loaded for each active -.B Device -section. -A -.B Device -section is considered active if it is referenced by an active -.B Screen -section. -.PP -.B Device -sections recognise some driver\-independent entries and -.BR Options , -which are described here. -Not all drivers make use of these -driver\-independent entries, and many of those that do don't require them -to be specified because the information is auto\-detected. -See the individual graphics driver manual pages for further information -about this, and for a description of the device\-specific options. -Note that most of the -.B Options -listed here (but not the other entries) may be specified in the -.B Screen -section instead of here in the -.B Device -section. -.TP 7 -.BI "BusID \*q" bus\-id \*q -This specifies the bus location of the graphics card. -For PCI/AGP cards, -the -.I bus\-id -string has the form -.BI PCI: bus : device : function -(e.g., \(lqPCI:1:0:0\(rq might be appropriate for an AGP card). -This field is usually optional in single-head configurations when using -the primary graphics card. -In multi-head configurations, or when using a secondary graphics card in a -single-head configuration, this entry is mandatory. -Its main purpose is to make an unambiguous connection between the device -section and the hardware it is representing. -This information can usually be found by running the pciaccess tool -scanpci. -.TP 7 -.BI "Screen " number -This option is mandatory for cards where a single PCI entity can drive more -than one display (i.e., multiple CRTCs sharing a single graphics accelerator -and video memory). -One -.B Device -section is required for each head, and this -parameter determines which head each of the -.B Device -sections applies to. -The legal values of -.I number -range from 0 to one less than the total number of heads per entity. -Most drivers require that the primary screen (0) be present. -.TP 7 -.BI "Chipset \*q" chipset \*q -This usually optional entry specifies the chipset used on the graphics -board. -In most cases this entry is not required because the drivers will probe the -hardware to determine the chipset type. -Don't specify it unless the driver-specific documentation recommends that you -do. -.TP 7 -.BI "Ramdac \*q" ramdac\-type \*q -This optional entry specifies the type of RAMDAC used on the graphics -board. -This is only used by a few of the drivers, and in most cases it is not -required because the drivers will probe the hardware to determine the -RAMDAC type where possible. -Don't specify it unless the driver-specific documentation recommends that you -do. -.TP 7 -.BI "DacSpeed " speed -.TP 7 -.BI "DacSpeed " "speed\-8 speed\-16 speed\-24 speed\-32" -This optional entry specifies the RAMDAC speed rating (which is usually -printed on the RAMDAC chip). -The speed is in MHz. -When one value is given, it applies to all framebuffer pixel sizes. -When multiple values are given, they apply to the framebuffer pixel sizes -8, 16, 24 and 32 respectively. -This is not used by many drivers, and only needs to be specified when the -speed rating of the RAMDAC is different from the defaults built in to -driver, or when the driver can't auto-detect the correct defaults. -Don't specify it unless the driver-specific documentation recommends that you -do. -.TP 7 -.BI "Clocks " "clock ..." -specifies the pixel that are on your graphics board. -The clocks are in MHz, and may be specified as a floating point number. -The value is stored internally to the nearest kHz. -The ordering of the clocks is important. -It must match the order in which they are selected on the graphics board. -Multiple -.B Clocks -lines may be specified, and each is concatenated to form the list. -Most drivers do not use this entry, and it is only required for some older -boards with non-programmable clocks. -Don't specify this entry unless the driver-specific documentation explicitly -recommends that you do. -.TP -.BI "ClockChip \*q" clockchip\-type \*q -This optional entry is used to specify the clock chip type on graphics -boards which have a programmable clock generator. -Only a few __xservername__ drivers support programmable clock chips. -For details, see the appropriate driver manual page. -.TP 7 -.BI "VideoRam " "mem" -This optional entry specifies the amount of video ram that is installed -on the graphics board. -This is measured in kBytes. -In most cases this is not required because the __xservername__ server probes -the graphics board to determine this quantity. -The driver-specific documentation should indicate when it might be needed. -.TP 7 -.BI "BiosBase " "baseaddress" -This optional entry specifies the base address of the video BIOS for -the VGA board. -This address is normally auto-detected, and should only be specified if the -driver-specific documentation recommends it. -.TP 7 -.BI "MemBase " "baseaddress" -This optional entry specifies the memory base address of a graphics -board's linear frame buffer. -This entry is not used by many drivers, and it should only be specified if -the driver-specific documentation recommends it. -.TP 7 -.BI "IOBase " "baseaddress" -This optional entry specifies the IO base address. -This entry is not used by many drivers, and it should only be specified if -the driver-specific documentation recommends it. -.TP 7 -.BI "ChipID " "id" -This optional entry specifies a numerical ID representing the chip type. -For PCI cards, it is usually the device ID. -This can be used to override the auto-detection, but that should only be done -when the driver-specific documentation recommends it. -.TP 7 -.BI "ChipRev " "rev" -This optional entry specifies the chip revision number. -This can be used to override the auto-detection, but that should only be done -when the driver-specific documentation recommends it. -.TP 7 -.BI "TextClockFreq " "freq" -This optional entry specifies the pixel clock frequency that is used -for the regular text mode. -The frequency is specified in MHz. -This is rarely used. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qModeDebug\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Enable printing of additional debugging information about modesetting to -the server log. -.ig -.TP 7 -This optional entry allows an IRQ number to be specified. -.. -.TP 7 -.B Options -Option flags may be specified in the -.B Device -sections. -These include driver\-specific options and driver\-independent options. -The former are described in the driver\-specific documentation. -Some of the latter are described below in the section about the -.B Screen -section, and they may also be included here. - -.SH "VIDEOADAPTOR SECTION" -Nobody wants to say how this works. -Maybe nobody knows ... - -.SH "MONITOR SECTION" -The config file may have multiple -.B Monitor -sections. -There should normally be at least one, for the monitor being used, -but a default configuration will be created when one isn't specified. -.PP -.B Monitor -sections have the following format: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qMonitor\*q" -.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q -.I " entries" -.I " ..." -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.PP -The only mandatory entry in a -.B Monitor -section is the -.B Identifier -entry. -.PP -The -.B Identifier -entry specifies the unique name for this monitor. -The -.B Monitor -section may be used to provide information about the specifications of the -monitor, monitor-specific -.BR Options , -and information about the video modes to use with the monitor. -.PP -With RandR 1.2-enabled drivers, monitor sections may be tied to specific -outputs of the video card. Using the name of the output defined by the video -driver plus the identifier of a monitor section, one associates a monitor -section with an output by adding an option to the Device section in the -following format: - -.B Option \*qMonitor-outputname\*q \*qmonitorsection\*q - -(for example, -.B Option \*qMonitor-VGA\*q \*qVGA monitor\*q -for a VGA output) -.PP -In the absence of specific association of monitor sections to outputs, if a -monitor section is present the server will associate it with an output to -preserve compatibility for previous single-head configurations. -.PP -Specifying video modes is optional because the server will use the DDC or other -information provided by the monitor to automatically configure the list of -modes available. -When modes are specified explicitly in the -.B Monitor -section (with the -.BR Modes , -.BR ModeLine , -or -.B UseModes -keywords), built-in modes with the same names are not included. -Built-in modes with different names are, however, still implicitly included, -when they meet the requirements of the monitor. -.PP -The entries that may be used in -.B Monitor -sections are described below. -.TP 7 -.BI "VendorName \*q" vendor \*q -This optional entry specifies the monitor's manufacturer. -.TP 7 -.BI "ModelName \*q" model \*q -This optional entry specifies the monitor's model. -.TP 7 -.BI "HorizSync " "horizsync\-range" -gives the range(s) of horizontal sync frequencies supported by the -monitor. -.I horizsync\-range -may be a comma separated list of either discrete values or ranges of -values. -A range of values is two values separated by a dash. -By default the values are in units of kHz. -They may be specified in MHz or Hz -if -.B MHz -or -.B Hz -is added to the end of the line. -The data given here is used by the __xservername__ server to determine if video -modes are within the specifications of the monitor. -This information should be available in the monitor's handbook. -If this entry is omitted, a default range of 28\-33kHz is used. -.TP 7 -.BI "VertRefresh " "vertrefresh\-range" -gives the range(s) of vertical refresh frequencies supported by the -monitor. -.I vertrefresh\-range -may be a comma separated list of either discrete values or ranges of -values. -A range of values is two values separated by a dash. -By default the values are in units of Hz. -They may be specified in MHz or kHz -if -.B MHz -or -.B kHz -is added to the end of the line. -The data given here is used by the __xservername__ server to determine if video -modes are within the specifications of the monitor. -This information should be available in the monitor's handbook. -If this entry is omitted, a default range of 43\-72Hz is used. -.TP 7 -.BI "DisplaySize " "width height" -This optional entry gives the width and height, in millimetres, of the -picture area of the monitor. -If given this is used to calculate the horizontal and vertical pitch (DPI) of -the screen. -.TP 7 -.BI "Gamma " "gamma\-value" -.TP 7 -.BI "Gamma " "red\-gamma green\-gamma blue\-gamma" -This is an optional entry that can be used to specify the gamma correction -for the monitor. -It may be specified as either a single value or as three separate RGB values. -The values should be in the range 0.1 to 10.0, and the default is 1.0. -Not all drivers are capable of using this information. -.TP 7 -.BI "UseModes \*q" modesection\-id \*q -Include the set of modes listed in the -.B Modes -section called -.IR modesection\-id. -This makes all of the modes defined in that section available for use by -this monitor. -.TP 7 -.BI "Mode \*q" name \*q -This is an optional multi-line entry that can be used to provide -definitions for video modes for the monitor. -In most cases this isn't necessary because the built-in set of VESA standard -modes will be sufficient. -The -.B Mode -keyword indicates the start of a multi-line video mode description. -The mode description is terminated with the -.B EndMode -keyword. -The mode description consists of the following entries: -.RS 7 -.TP 4 -.BI "DotClock " clock -is the dot (pixel) clock rate to be used for the mode. -.TP 4 -.BI "HTimings " "hdisp hsyncstart hsyncend htotal" -specifies the horizontal timings for the mode. -.TP 4 -.BI "VTimings " "vdisp vsyncstart vsyncend vtotal" -specifies the vertical timings for the mode. -.TP 4 -.BI "Flags \*q" flag \*q " ..." -specifies an optional set of mode flags, each of which is a separate -string in double quotes. -.B \*qInterlace\*q -indicates that the mode is interlaced. -.B \*qDoubleScan\*q -indicates a mode where each scanline is doubled. -.B \*q+HSync\*q -and -.B \*q\-HSync\*q -can be used to select the polarity of the HSync signal. -.B \*q+VSync\*q -and -.B \*q\-VSync\*q -can be used to select the polarity of the VSync signal. -.B \*qComposite\*q -can be used to specify composite sync on hardware where this is supported. -Additionally, on some hardware, -.B \*q+CSync\*q -and -.B \*q\-CSync\*q -may be used to select the composite sync polarity. -.TP 4 -.BI "HSkew " hskew -specifies the number of pixels (towards the right edge of the screen) by -which the display enable signal is to be skewed. -Not all drivers use this information. -This option might become necessary to override the default value supplied -by the server (if any). -\(lqRoving\(rq horizontal lines indicate this value needs to be increased. -If the last few pixels on a scan line appear on the left of the screen, -this value should be decreased. -.TP 4 -.BI "VScan " vscan -specifies the number of times each scanline is painted on the screen. -Not all drivers use this information. -Values less than 1 are treated as 1, which is the default. -Generally, the -.B \*qDoubleScan\*q -.B Flag -mentioned above doubles this value. -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "ModeLine \*q" name \*q " mode\-description" -This entry is a more compact version of the -.B Mode -entry, and it also can be used to specify video modes for the monitor. -is a single line format for specifying video modes. -In most cases this isn't necessary because the built\-in set of VESA -standard modes will be sufficient. -.PP -.RS 7 -The -.I mode\-description -is in four sections, the first three of which are mandatory. -The first is the dot (pixel) clock. -This is a single number specifying the pixel clock rate for the mode in -MHz. -The second section is a list of four numbers specifying the horizontal -timings. -These numbers are the -.IR hdisp , -.IR hsyncstart , -.IR hsyncend , -and -.I htotal -values. -The third section is a list of four numbers specifying the vertical -timings. -These numbers are the -.IR vdisp , -.IR vsyncstart , -.IR vsyncend , -and -.I vtotal -values. -The final section is a list of flags specifying other characteristics of -the mode. -.B Interlace -indicates that the mode is interlaced. -.B DoubleScan -indicates a mode where each scanline is doubled. -.B +HSync -and -.B \-HSync -can be used to select the polarity of the HSync signal. -.B +VSync -and -.B \-VSync -can be used to select the polarity of the VSync signal. -.B Composite -can be used to specify composite sync on hardware where this is supported. -Additionally, on some hardware, -.B +CSync -and -.B \-CSync -may be used to select the composite sync polarity. -The -.B HSkew -and -.B VScan -options mentioned above in the -.B Modes -entry description can also be used here. -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qDPMS\*q " \*qbool\*q -This option controls whether the server should enable the DPMS extension -for power management for this screen. The default is to enable the -extension. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qSyncOnGreen\*q " \*qbool\*q -This option controls whether the video card should drive the sync signal -on the green color pin. Not all cards support this option, and most -monitors do not require it. The default is off. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qPrimary\*q " \*qbool\*q -This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be treated as the primary -monitor. (RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qPreferredMode\*q " \*qstring\*q -This optional entry specifies a mode to be marked as the preferred initial mode -of the monitor. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qPosition\*q " "\*qx y\*q" -This optional entry specifies the position of the monitor within the X -screen. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qLeftOf\*q " \*qoutput\*q -This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be positioned to the -left of the output (not monitor) of the given name. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qRightOf\*q " \*qoutput\*q -This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be positioned to the -right of the output (not monitor) of the given name. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qAbove\*q " \*qoutput\*q -This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be positioned above the -output (not monitor) of the given name. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qBelow\*q " \*qoutput\*q -This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be positioned below the -output (not monitor) of the given name. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qEnable\*q " \*qbool\*q -This optional entry specifies whether the monitor should be turned on -at startup. By default, the server will attempt to enable all connected -monitors. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qDefaultModes\*q " \*qbool\*q -This optional entry specifies whether the server should add supported default -modes to the list of modes offered on this monitor. By default, the server -will add default modes; you should only disable this if you can guarantee -that EDID will be available at all times, or if you have added custom modelines -which the server can use. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qMinClock\*q " \*qfrequency\*q -This optional entry specifies the minimum dot clock, in kHz, that is supported -by the monitor. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qMaxClock\*q " \*qfrequency\*q -This optional entry specifies the maximum dot clock, in kHz, that is supported -by the monitor. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qIgnore\*q " \*qbool\*q -This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be ignored entirely, -and not reported through RandR. This is useful if the hardware reports the -presence of outputs that don't exist. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) -.TP 7 -.BI "Option " "\*qRotate\*q " \*qrotation\*q -This optional entry specifies the initial rotation of the given monitor. -Valid values for rotation are \*qnormal\*q, \*qleft\*q, \*qright\*q, and -\*qinverted\*q. -(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only) - -.SH "MODES SECTION" -The config file may have multiple -.B Modes -sections, or none. -These sections provide a way of defining sets of video modes independently -of the -.B Monitor -sections. -.B Monitor -sections may include the definitions provided in these sections by -using the -.B UseModes -keyword. -In most cases the -.B Modes -sections are not necessary because the built\-in set of VESA standard modes -will be sufficient. -.PP -.B Modes -sections have the following format: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qModes\*q" -.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q -.I " entries" -.I " ..." -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.PP -The -.B Identifier -entry specifies the unique name for this set of mode descriptions. -The other entries permitted in -.B Modes -sections are the -.B Mode -and -.B ModeLine -entries that are described above in the -.B Monitor -section. -.SH "SCREEN SECTION" -The config file may have multiple -.B Screen -sections. -There must be at least one, for the \(lqscreen\(rq being used. -A \(lqscreen\(rq represents the binding of a graphics device -.RB ( Device -section) and a monitor -.RB ( Monitor -section). -A -.B Screen -section is considered \(lqactive\(rq if it is referenced by an active -.B ServerLayout -section or by the -.B \-screen -command line option. -If neither of those is present, the first -.B Screen -section found in the config file is considered the active one. -.PP -.B Screen -sections have the following format: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qScreen\*q" -.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q -.BI " Device \*q" devid \*q -.BI " Monitor \*q" monid \*q -.I " entries" -.I " ..." -.BI " SubSection \*qDisplay\*q" -.I " entries" -.I " ... -.B " EndSubSection" -.I " ..." -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.PP -The -.B Identifier -and -.B Device -entries are mandatory. -All others are optional. -.PP -The -.B Identifier -entry specifies the unique name for this screen. -The -.B Screen -section provides information specific to the whole screen, including -screen\-specific -.BR Options . -In multi\-head configurations, there will be multiple active -.B Screen -sections, one for each head. -The entries available -for this section are: -.TP 7 -.BI "Device \*q" device\-id \*q -This mandatory entry specifies the -.B Device -section to be used for this screen. -This is what ties a specific graphics card to a screen. -The -.I device\-id -must match the -.B Identifier -of a -.B Device -section in the config file. -.TP 7 -.BI "Monitor \*q" monitor\-id \*q -specifies which monitor description is to be used for this screen. -If a -.B Monitor -name is not specified, a default configuration is used. -Currently the default configuration may not function as expected on all -platforms. -.TP 7 -.BI "VideoAdaptor \*q" xv\-id \*q -specifies an optional Xv video adaptor description to be used with this -screen. -.TP 7 -.BI "DefaultDepth " depth -specifies which color depth the server should use by default. -The -.B \-depth -command line option can be used to override this. -If neither is specified, the default depth is driver\-specific, but in most -cases is 8. -.TP 7 -.BI "DefaultFbBpp " bpp -specifies which framebuffer layout to use by default. -The -.B \-fbbpp -command line option can be used to override this. -In most cases the driver will chose the best default value for this. -The only case where there is even a choice in this value is for depth 24, -where some hardware supports both a packed 24 bit framebuffer layout and a -sparse 32 bit framebuffer layout. -.TP 7 -.B Options -Various -.B Option -flags may be specified in the -.B Screen -section. -Some are driver\-specific and are described in the driver documentation. -Others are driver\-independent, and will eventually be described here. -.\" XXX These should really be in an xaa man page. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qAccel\*q" -Enables XAA (X Acceleration Architecture), a mechanism that makes video cards' -2D hardware acceleration available to the __xservername__ server. -This option is on by default, but it may be necessary to turn it off if -there are bugs in the driver. -There are many options to disable specific accelerated operations, listed -below. -Note that disabling an operation will have no effect if the operation is -not accelerated (whether due to lack of support in the hardware or in the -driver). -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qInitPrimary\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Use the Int10 module to initialize the primary graphics card. -Normally, only secondary cards are soft-booted using the Int10 module, as the -primary card has already been initialized by the BIOS at boot time. -Default: false. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qNoInt10\*q \*q" boolean \*q -Disables the Int10 module, a module that uses the int10 call to the BIOS -of the graphics card to initialize it. -Default: false. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qNoMTRR\*q" -Disables MTRR (Memory Type Range Register) support, a feature of modern -processors which can improve video performance by a factor of up to 2.5. -Some hardware has buggy MTRR support, and some video drivers have been -known to exhibit problems when MTRR's are used. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoCPUToScreenColorExpandFill\*q" -Disables accelerated rectangular expansion blits from source patterns -stored in system memory (using a memory\-mapped aperture). -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoColor8x8PatternFillRect\*q" -Disables accelerated fills of a rectangular region with a full\-color -pattern. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoColor8x8PatternFillTrap\*q" -Disables accelerated fills of a trapezoidal region with a full\-color -pattern. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoDashedBresenhamLine\*q" -Disables accelerated dashed Bresenham line draws. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoDashedTwoPointLine\*q" -Disables accelerated dashed line draws between two arbitrary points. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoImageWriteRect\*q" -Disables accelerated transfers of full\-color rectangular patterns from -system memory to video memory (using a memory\-mapped aperture). -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoMono8x8PatternFillRect\*q" -Disables accelerated fills of a rectangular region with a monochrome -pattern. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoMono8x8PatternFillTrap\*q" -Disables accelerated fills of a trapezoidal region with a monochrome -pattern. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoOffscreenPixmaps\*q" -Disables accelerated draws into pixmaps stored in offscreen video memory. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoPixmapCache\*q" -Disables caching of patterns in offscreen video memory. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoScanlineCPUToScreenColorExpandFill\*q" -Disables accelerated rectangular expansion blits from source patterns -stored in system memory (one scan line at a time). -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoScanlineImageWriteRect\*q" -Disables accelerated transfers of full\-color rectangular patterns from -system memory to video memory (one scan line at a time). -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoScreenToScreenColorExpandFill\*q" -Disables accelerated rectangular expansion blits from source patterns -stored in offscreen video memory. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoScreenToScreenCopy\*q" -Disables accelerated copies of rectangular regions from one part of -video memory to another part of video memory. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidBresenhamLine\*q" -Disables accelerated solid Bresenham line draws. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidFillRect\*q" -Disables accelerated solid\-color fills of rectangles. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidFillTrap\*q" -Disables accelerated solid\-color fills of Bresenham trapezoids. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidHorVertLine\*q" -Disables accelerated solid horizontal and vertical line draws. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidTwoPointLine\*q" -Disables accelerated solid line draws between two arbitrary points. -.PP -Each -.B Screen -section may optionally contain one or more -.B Display -subsections. -Those subsections provide depth/fbbpp specific configuration information, -and the one chosen depends on the depth and/or fbbpp that is being used for -the screen. -The -.B Display -subsection format is described in the section below. - -.SH "DISPLAY SUBSECTION" -Each -.B Screen -section may have multiple -.B Display -subsections. -The \(lqactive\(rq -.B Display -subsection is the first that matches the depth and/or fbbpp values being -used, or failing that, the first that has neither a depth or fbbpp value -specified. -The -.B Display -subsections are optional. -When there isn't one that matches the depth and/or fbbpp values being used, -all the parameters that can be specified here fall back to their defaults. -.PP -.B Display -subsections have the following format: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B " SubSection \*qDisplay\*q" -.BI " Depth " depth -.I " entries" -.I " ..." -.B " EndSubSection" -.fi -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "Depth " depth -This entry specifies what colour depth the -.B Display -subsection is to be used for. -This entry is usually specified, but it may be omitted to create a match\-all -.B Display -subsection or when wishing to match only against the -.B FbBpp -parameter. -The range of -.I depth -values that are allowed depends on the driver. -Most drivers support 8, 15, 16 and 24. -Some also support 1 and/or 4, and some may support other values (like 30). -Note: -.I depth -means the number of bits in a pixel that are actually used to determine -the pixel colour. -32 is not a valid -.I depth -value. -Most hardware that uses 32 bits per pixel only uses 24 of them to hold the -colour information, which means that the colour depth is 24, not 32. -.TP 7 -.BI "FbBpp " bpp -This entry specifies the framebuffer format this -.B Display -subsection is to be used for. -This entry is only needed when providing depth 24 configurations that allow -a choice between a 24 bpp packed framebuffer format and a 32bpp sparse -framebuffer format. -In most cases this entry should not be used. -.TP 7 -.BI "Weight " "red\-weight green\-weight blue\-weight" -This optional entry specifies the relative RGB weighting to be used -for a screen is being used at depth 16 for drivers that allow multiple -formats. -This may also be specified from the command line with the -.B \-weight -option (see -.BR __xservername__(__appmansuffix__)). -.TP 7 -.BI "Virtual " "xdim ydim" -This optional entry specifies the virtual screen resolution to be used. -.I xdim -must be a multiple of either 8 or 16 for most drivers, and a multiple -of 32 when running in monochrome mode. -The given value will be rounded down if this is not the case. -Video modes which are too large for the specified virtual size will be -rejected. -If this entry is not present, the virtual screen resolution will be set to -accommodate all the valid video modes given in the -.B Modes -entry. -Some drivers/hardware combinations do not support virtual screens. -Refer to the appropriate driver\-specific documentation for details. -.TP 7 -.BI "ViewPort " "x0 y0" -This optional entry sets the upper left corner of the initial display. -This is only relevant when the virtual screen resolution is different -from the resolution of the initial video mode. -If this entry is not given, then the initial display will be centered in -the virtual display area. -.TP 7 -.BI "Modes \*q" mode\-name \*q " ..." -This optional entry specifies the list of video modes to use. -Each -.I mode\-name -specified must be in double quotes. -They must correspond to those specified or referenced in the appropriate -.B Monitor -section (including implicitly referenced built\-in VESA standard modes). -The server will delete modes from this list which don't satisfy various -requirements. -The first valid mode in this list will be the default display mode for -startup. -The list of valid modes is converted internally into a circular list. -It is possible to switch to the next mode with -.B Ctrl+Alt+Keypad\-Plus -and to the previous mode with -.BR Ctrl+Alt+Keypad\-Minus . -When this entry is omitted, the valid modes referenced by the appropriate -.B Monitor -section will be used. If the -.B Monitor -section contains no modes, then the selection will be taken from the -built-in VESA standard modes. -.TP 7 -.BI "Visual \*q" visual\-name \*q -This optional entry sets the default root visual type. -This may also be specified from the command line (see the -.BR Xserver(__appmansuffix__) -man page). -The visual types available for depth 8 are (default is -.BR PseudoColor ): -.PP -.RS 11 -.nf -.B StaticGray -.B GrayScale -.B StaticColor -.B PseudoColor -.B TrueColor -.B DirectColor -.fi -.RE -.PP -.RS 7 -The visual type available for the depths 15, 16 and 24 are (default is -.BR TrueColor ): -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B TrueColor -.B DirectColor -.fi -.RE -.PP -Not all drivers support -.B DirectColor -at these depths. -.PP -The visual types available for the depth 4 are (default is -.BR StaticColor ): -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B StaticGray -.B GrayScale -.B StaticColor -.B PseudoColor -.fi -.RE -.PP -The visual type available for the depth 1 (monochrome) is -.BR StaticGray . -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "Black " "red green blue" -This optional entry allows the \(lqblack\(rq colour to be specified. -This is only supported at depth 1. -The default is black. -.TP 7 -.BI "White " "red green blue" -This optional entry allows the \(lqwhite\(rq colour to be specified. -This is only supported at depth 1. -The default is white. -.TP 7 -.B Options -Option flags may be specified in the -.B Display -subsections. -These may include driver\-specific options and driver\-independent options. -The former are described in the driver\-specific documentation. -Some of the latter are described above in the section about the -.B Screen -section, and they may also be included here. -.SH "SERVERLAYOUT SECTION" -The config file may have multiple -.B ServerLayout -sections. -A \(lqserver layout\(rq represents the binding of one or more screens -.RB ( Screen -sections) and one or more input devices -.RB ( InputDevice -sections) to form a complete configuration. -In multi\-head configurations, it also specifies the relative layout of the -heads. -A -.B ServerLayout -section is considered \(lqactive\(rq if it is referenced by the -.B \-layout -command line option or by an -.B "Option \*qDefaultServerLayout\*q" -entry in the -.B ServerFlags -section (the former takes precedence over the latter). -If those options are not used, the first -.B ServerLayout -section found in the config file is considered the active one. -If no -.B ServerLayout -sections are present, the single active screen and two active (core) -input devices are selected as described in the relevant sections above. -.PP -.B ServerLayout -sections have the following format: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qServerLayout\*q" -.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q -.BI " Screen \*q" screen\-id \*q -.I " ..." -.BI " InputDevice \*q" idev\-id \*q -.I " ..." -.I " options" -.I " ..." -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.PP -Each -.B ServerLayout -section must have an -.B Identifier -entry and at least one -.B Screen -entry. -.PP -The -.B Identifier -entry specifies the unique name for this server layout. -The -.B ServerLayout -section provides information specific to the whole session, including -session\-specific -.BR Options . -The -.B ServerFlags -options (described above) may be specified here, and ones given here -override those given in the -.B ServerFlags -section. -.PP -The entries that may be used in this section are described here. -.TP 7 -.BI "Screen " "screen\-num" " \*qscreen\-id\*q " "position\-information" -One of these entries must be given for each screen being used in -a session. -The -.I screen\-id -field is mandatory, and specifies the -.B Screen -section being referenced. -The -.I screen\-num -field is optional, and may be used to specify the screen number -in multi\-head configurations. -When this field is omitted, the screens will be numbered in the order that -they are listed in. -The numbering starts from 0, and must be consecutive. -The -.I position\-information -field describes the way multiple screens are positioned. -There are a number of different ways that this information can be provided: -.RS 7 -.TP 4 -.I "x y" -.TP 4 -.BI "Absolute " "x y" -These both specify that the upper left corner's coordinates are -.RI ( x , y ). -The -.B Absolute -keyword is optional. -Some older versions of XFree86 (4.2 and earlier) don't recognise the -.B Absolute -keyword, so it's safest to just specify the coordinates without it. -.TP 4 -.BI "RightOf \*q" screen\-id \*q -.TP 4 -.BI "LeftOf \*q" screen\-id \*q -.TP 4 -.BI "Above \*q" screen\-id \*q -.TP 4 -.BI "Below \*q" screen\-id \*q -.TP 4 -.BI "Relative \*q" screen\-id \*q " x y" -These give the screen's location relative to another screen. -The first four position the screen immediately to the right, left, above or -below the other screen. -When positioning to the right or left, the top edges are aligned. -When positioning above or below, the left edges are aligned. -The -.B Relative -form specifies the offset of the screen's origin (upper left corner) -relative to the origin of another screen. -.RE -.TP 7 -.BI "InputDevice \*q" idev\-id "\*q \*q" option \*q " ..." -One of these entries should be given for each input device being used in -a session. -Normally at least two are required, one each for the core pointer and -keyboard devices. -If either of those is missing, suitable -.B InputDevice -entries are searched for using the method described above in the -.B INPUTDEVICE -section. The -.I idev\-id -field is mandatory, and specifies the name of the -.B InputDevice -section being referenced. -Multiple -.I option -fields may be specified, each in double quotes. -The options permitted here are any that may also be given in the -.B InputDevice -sections. -Normally only session\-specific input device options would be used here. -The most commonly used options are: -.PP -.RS 11 -.nf -.B \*qCorePointer\*q -.B \*qCoreKeyboard\*q -.B \*qSendCoreEvents\*q -.fi -.RE -.PP -.RS 7 -and the first two should normally be used to indicate the core pointer -and core keyboard devices respectively. -.RE -.TP 7 -.B Options -In addition to the following, any option permitted in the -.B ServerFlags -section may also be specified here. -When the same option appears in both places, the value given here overrides -the one given in the -.B ServerFlags -section. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qIsolateDevice\*q \*q" bus\-id \*q -Restrict device resets to the specified -.IR bus\-id . -See the -.B BusID -option (described in -.BR "DEVICE SECTION" , -above) for the format of the -.I bus\-id -parameter. -This option overrides -.BR SingleCard , -if specified. -At present, only PCI devices can be isolated in this manner. -.TP 7 -.BI "Option \*qSingleCard\*q \*q" boolean \*q -As -.BR IsolateDevice , -except that the bus ID of the first device in the layout is used. -.PP -Here is an example of a -.B ServerLayout -section for a dual headed configuration with two mice: -.PP -.RS 4 -.nf -.B "Section \*qServerLayout\*q" -.B " Identifier \*qLayout 1\*q" -.B " Screen \*qMGA 1\*q" -.B " Screen \*qMGA 2\*q RightOf \*qMGA 1\*q" -.B " InputDevice \*qKeyboard 1\*q \*qCoreKeyboard\*q" -.B " InputDevice \*qMouse 1\*q \*qCorePointer\*q" -.B " InputDevice \*qMouse 2\*q \*qSendCoreEvents\*q" -.B " Option \*qBlankTime\*q \*q5\*q" -.B "EndSection" -.fi -.RE -.SH "DRI SECTION" -This optional section is used to provide some information for the -Direct Rendering Infrastructure. -Details about the format of this section can be found on-line at -.IR <http://dri.freedesktop.org/> . -.SH "VENDOR SECTION" -The optional -.B Vendor -section may be used to provide vendor\-specific configuration information. -Multiple -.B Vendor -sections may be present, and they may contain an -.B Identifier -entry and multiple -.B Option -flags. -The data therein is not used in this release. -.PP -.SH "SEE ALSO" -General: -.BR X (__miscmansuffix__), -.BR Xserver (__appmansuffix__), -.BR __xservername__ (__appmansuffix__), -.BR cvt (__appmansuffix__), -.BR gtf (__appmansuffix__). -.PP -.B "Not all modules or interfaces are available on all platforms." -.PP -Display drivers: -.BR apm (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR ati (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR chips (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR cirrus (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR cyrix (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR fbdev (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR glide (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR glint (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR i128 (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR i740 (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR imstt (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR intel (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR mga (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR neomagic (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR nv (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR openchrome (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR r128 (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR radeon (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR rendition (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR savage (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR s3virge (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR siliconmotion (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR sis (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR sisusb (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR sunbw2 (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR suncg14 (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR suncg3 (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR suncg6 (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR sunffb (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR sunleo (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR suntcx (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR tdfx (__drivermansuffix__), -.\" .BR tga (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR trident (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR tseng (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR vesa (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR vmware (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR voodoo (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR wsfb (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR xgi (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR xgixp (__drivermansuffix__). -.PP -Input drivers: -.BR acecad (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR citron (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR elographics (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR evdev (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR fpit (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR joystick (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR kbd (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR mousedrv (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR mutouch (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR penmount (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR synaptics (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR vmmouse (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR void (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR wacom (__drivermansuffix__). -.PP -Other modules and interfaces: -.BR exa (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR fbdevhw (__drivermansuffix__), -.\" .BR shadowfb (__drivermansuffix__), -.BR v4l (__drivermansuffix__). -.br -.SH AUTHORS -This manual page was largely rewritten by David Dawes -.IR <dawes@xfree86.org> . +.\" shorthand for double quote that works everywhere.
+.ds q \N'34'
+.TH __xconfigfile__ __filemansuffix__ __vendorversion__
+.SH NAME
+__xconfigfile__ and __xconfigdir__ \- configuration files for
+__xservername__ X server
+.SH INTRODUCTION
+.B __xservername__
+supports several mechanisms for supplying/obtaining configuration and
+run-time parameters: command line options, environment variables, the
+__xconfigfile__ and __xconfigdir__ configuration files, auto-detection,
+and fallback defaults. When the same information is supplied in more
+than one way, the highest precedence mechanism is used. The list of
+mechanisms is ordered from highest precedence to lowest. Note that not
+all parameters can be supplied via all methods. The available command
+line options and environment variables (and some defaults) are
+described in the Xserver(__appmansuffix__) and
+__xservername__(__appmansuffix__) manual pages. Most configuration file
+parameters, with their defaults, are described below. Driver and module
+specific configuration parameters are described in the relevant driver
+or module manual page.
+.SH DESCRIPTION
+.B __xservername__
+uses a configuration file called
+.I __xconfigfile__
+and files ending in the suffix
+.I .conf
+from the directory
+.I __xconfigdir__
+for its initial setup.
+The
+.I __xconfigfile__
+configuration file is searched for in the following places when the
+server is started as a normal user:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.IR /etc/X11/ <cmdline>
+.IR __projectroot__/etc/X11/ <cmdline>
+.IB /etc/X11/ $XORGCONFIG
+.IB __projectroot__/etc/X11/ $XORGCONFIG
+.I /etc/X11/__xconfigfile__
+.I /etc/__xconfigfile__
+.IR __projectroot__/etc/X11/__xconfigfile__. <hostname>
+.I __projectroot__/etc/X11/__xconfigfile__
+.IR __projectroot__/lib/X11/__xconfigfile__. <hostname>
+.I __projectroot__/lib/X11/__xconfigfile__
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+where
+.I <cmdline>
+is a relative path (with no \(lq..\(rq components) specified with the
+.B \-config
+command line option,
+.B $XORGCONFIG
+is the relative path (with no \(lq..\(rq components) specified by that
+environment variable, and
+.I <hostname>
+is the machine's hostname as reported by
+.BR gethostname (__libmansuffix__).
+.PP
+When the __xservername__ server is started by the \(lqroot\(rq user, the config file
+search locations are as follows:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+<cmdline>
+.IR /etc/X11/ <cmdline>
+.IR __projectroot__/etc/X11/ <cmdline>
+.B $XORGCONFIG
+.IB /etc/X11/ $XORGCONFIG
+.IB __projectroot__/etc/X11/ $XORGCONFIG
+.I /etc/X11/__xconfigfile__
+.I /etc/__xconfigfile__
+.IR __projectroot__/etc/X11/__xconfigfile__. <hostname>
+.I __projectroot__/etc/X11/__xconfigfile__
+.IR __projectroot__/lib/X11/__xconfigfile__. <hostname>
+.I __projectroot__/lib/X11/__xconfigfile__
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+where
+.I <cmdline>
+is the path specified with the
+.B \-config
+command line option (which may be absolute or relative),
+.B $XORGCONFIG
+is the path specified by that
+environment variable (absolute or relative),
+.B $HOME
+is the path specified by that environment variable (usually the home
+directory), and
+.I <hostname>
+is the machine's hostname as reported by
+.BR gethostname (__libmansuffix__).
+.PP
+Additional configuration files are searched for in the following
+directories when the server is started as a normal user:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.IR /etc/X11/ <cmdline>
+.IR __sysconfdir__/X11/ <cmdline>
+.I /etc/X11/__xconfigdir__
+.I __sysconfdir__/X11/__xconfigdir__
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+where
+.I <cmdline>
+is a relative path (with no \(lq..\(rq components) specified with the
+.B \-configdir
+command line option.
+.PP
+When the __xservername__ server is started by the \(lqroot\(rq user, the
+config directory search locations are as follows:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+<cmdline>
+.IR /etc/X11/ <cmdline>
+.IR __sysconfdir__/X11/ <cmdline>
+.I /etc/X11/__xconfigdir__
+.I __sysconfdir__/X11/__xconfigdir__
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+where
+.I <cmdline>
+is the path specified with the
+.B \-configdir
+command line option (which may be absolute or relative).
+.PP
+Finally, configuration files will also be searched for in directories
+reserved for system use. These are to separate configuration files from
+the vendor or 3rd party packages from those of local administration.
+These files are found in the following directories:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.I /usr/share/X11/__xconfigdir__
+.I __datadir__/X11/__xconfigdir__
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The
+.I __xconfigfile__
+and
+.I __xconfigdir__
+files are composed of a number of sections which may be present in any order,
+or omitted to use default configuration values.
+Each section has the form:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.BI "Section \*q" SectionName \*q
+.RI " " SectionEntry
+ ...
+.B EndSection
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The section names are:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.BR "Files " "File pathnames"
+.BR "ServerFlags " "Server flags"
+.BR "Module " "Dynamic module loading"
+.BR "Extensions " "Extension enabling"
+.BR "InputDevice " "Input device description"
+.BR "InputClass " "Input class description"
+.BR "Device " "Graphics device description"
+.BR "VideoAdaptor " "Xv video adaptor description"
+.BR "Monitor " "Monitor description"
+.BR "Modes " "Video modes descriptions"
+.BR "Screen " "Screen configuration"
+.BR "ServerLayout " "Overall layout"
+.BR "DRI " "DRI\-specific configuration"
+.BR "Vendor " "Vendor\-specific configuration"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The following obsolete section names are still recognised for compatibility
+purposes.
+In new config files, the
+.B InputDevice
+section should be used instead.
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.BR "Keyboard " "Keyboard configuration"
+.BR "Pointer " "Pointer/mouse configuration"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The old
+.B XInput
+section is no longer recognised.
+.PP
+The
+.B ServerLayout
+sections are at the highest level.
+They bind together the input and output devices that will be used in a session.
+The input devices are described in the
+.B InputDevice
+sections.
+Output devices usually consist of multiple independent components (e.g.,
+a graphics board and a monitor).
+These multiple components are bound together in the
+.B Screen
+sections, and it is these that are referenced by the
+.B ServerLayout
+section.
+Each
+.B Screen
+section binds together a graphics board and a monitor.
+The graphics boards are described in the
+.B Device
+sections, and the monitors are described in the
+.B Monitor
+sections.
+.PP
+Config file keywords are case\-insensitive, and \(lq_\(rq characters are
+ignored.
+Most strings (including
+.B Option
+names) are also case-insensitive, and insensitive to white space and
+\(lq_\(rq characters.
+.PP
+Each config file entry usually takes up a single line in the file. They
+consist of a keyword, which is possibly followed by one or more arguments,
+with the number and types of the arguments depending on the keyword.
+The argument types are:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.BR "Integer " "an integer number in decimal, hex or octal"
+.BR "Real " "a floating point number"
+.BR "String " "a string enclosed in double quote marks (\*q)"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+Note: hex integer values must be prefixed with \(lq0x\(rq, and octal values
+with \(lq0\(rq.
+.PP
+A special keyword called
+.B Option
+may be used to provide free\-form data to various components of the server.
+The
+.B Option
+keyword takes either one or two string arguments.
+The first is the option name, and the optional second argument is the
+option value.
+Some commonly used option value types include:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.BR "Integer " "an integer number in decimal, hex or octal"
+.BR "Real " "a floating point number"
+.BR "String " "a sequence of characters"
+.BR "Boolean " "a boolean value (see below)"
+.BR "Frequency " "a frequency value (see below)"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+Note that
+.I all
+.B Option
+values, not just strings, must be enclosed in quotes.
+.PP
+Boolean options may optionally have a value specified.
+When no value is specified, the option's value is
+.BR TRUE .
+The following boolean option values are recognised as
+.BR TRUE :
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.BR 1 ,
+.BR on ,
+.BR true ,
+.B yes
+.RE
+.PP
+and the following boolean option values are recognised as
+.BR FALSE :
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.BR 0 ,
+.BR off ,
+.BR false ,
+.B no
+.RE
+.PP
+If an option name is prefixed with
+.RB \*q No \*q,
+then the option value is negated.
+.PP
+Example: the following option entries are equivalent:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Option \*qAccel\*q \*qOff\*q"
+.B "Option \*qNoAccel\*q"
+.B "Option \*qNoAccel\*q \*qOn\*q"
+.B "Option \*qAccel\*q \*qfalse\*q"
+.B "Option \*qAccel\*q \*qno\*q"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+Frequency option values consist of a real number that is optionally
+followed by one of the following frequency units:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.BR Hz ,
+.BR k ,
+.BR kHz ,
+.BR M ,
+.B MHz
+.RE
+.PP
+When the unit name is omitted, the correct units will be determined from
+the value and the expectations of the appropriate range of the value.
+It is recommended that the units always be specified when using frequency
+option values to avoid any errors in determining the value.
+.SH "FILES SECTION"
+The
+.B Files
+section is used to specify some path names required by the server.
+Some of these paths can also be set from the command line (see
+.BR Xserver (__appmansuffix__)
+and
+.BR __xservername__ (__appmansuffix__)).
+The command line settings override the values specified in the config
+file.
+The
+.B Files
+section is optional, as are all of the entries that may appear in it.
+.PP
+The entries that can appear in this section are:
+.TP 7
+.BI "FontPath \*q" path \*q
+sets the search path for fonts.
+This path is a comma separated list of font path elements which the __xservername__
+server searches for font databases.
+Multiple
+.B FontPath
+entries may be specified, and they will be concatenated to build up the
+fontpath used by the server. Font path elements can be absolute
+directory paths, catalogue directories or a font server identifier. The
+formats of the later two are explained below:
+.PP
+.RS 7
+Catalogue directories:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+Catalogue directories can be specified using the prefix \fBcatalogue:\fR
+before the directory name. The directory can then be populated with
+symlinks pointing to the real font directories, using the following
+syntax in the symlink name:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.IR <identifier> : [attribute]: pri= <priority>
+.RE
+.PP
+where
+.I <identifier>
+is an alphanumeric identifier,
+.I [attribute]
+is an attribute which will be passed to the underlying FPE and
+.I <priority>
+is a number used to order the fontfile FPEs. Examples:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.I 75dpi:unscaled:pri=20 -> /usr/share/X11/fonts/75dpi
+.I gscript:pri=60 -> /usr/share/fonts/default/ghostscript
+.I misc:unscaled:pri=10 \-> /usr/share/X11/fonts/misc
+.fi
+.PP
+.RE .RE .RE
+.PP
+.RS 7
+Font server identifiers:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+Font server identifiers have the form:
+.RS 4
+.PP
+.IR <trans> / <hostname> : <port\-number>
+.RE
+.PP
+where
+.I <trans>
+is the transport type to use to connect to the font server (e.g.,
+.B unix
+for UNIX\-domain sockets or
+.B tcp
+for a TCP/IP connection),
+.I <hostname>
+is the hostname of the machine running the font server, and
+.I <port\-number>
+is the port number that the font server is listening on (usually 7100).
+.RE
+.PP
+When this entry is not specified in the config file, the server falls back
+to the compiled\-in default font path, which contains the following
+font path elements (which can be set inside a catalogue directory):
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/misc/
+.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/TTF/
+.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/OTF/
+.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/Type1/
+.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/100dpi/
+.I __datadir__/fonts/X11/75dpi/
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+Font path elements that are found to be invalid are removed from the
+font path when the server starts up.
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "ModulePath \*q" path \*q
+sets the search path for loadable __xservername__ server modules.
+This path is a comma separated list of directories which the __xservername__ server
+searches for loadable modules loading in the order specified.
+Multiple
+.B ModulePath
+entries may be specified, and they will be concatenated to build the
+module search path used by the server. The default module path is
+.PP
+.RS 11
+__modulepath__
+.RE
+.\" The LogFile keyword is not currently implemented
+.ig
+.TP 7
+.BI "LogFile \*q" path \*q
+sets the name of the __xservername__ server log file.
+The default log file name is
+.PP
+.RS 11
+.RI __logdir__/__xservername__. <n> .log
+.RE
+.PP
+.RS 7
+where
+.I <n>
+is the display number for the __xservername__ server.
+..
+.TP 7
+.BI "XkbDir \*q" path \*q
+sets the base directory for keyboard layout files. The
+.B \-xkbdir
+command line option can be used to override this. The default directory is
+.PP
+.RS 11
+__xkbdir__
+.RE
+.SH "SERVERFLAGS SECTION"
+In addition to options specific to this section (described below), the
+.B ServerFlags
+section is used to specify some global
+__xservername__ server options.
+All of the entries in this section are
+.BR Options ,
+although for compatibility purposes some of the old style entries are
+still recognised.
+Those old style entries are not documented here, and using them is
+discouraged.
+The
+.B ServerFlags
+section is optional, as are the entries that may be specified in it.
+.PP
+.B Options
+specified in this section (with the exception of the
+.B \*qDefaultServerLayout\*q
+.BR Option )
+may be overridden by
+.B Options
+specified in the active
+.B ServerLayout
+section.
+Options with command line equivalents are overridden when their command
+line equivalent is used.
+The options recognised by this section are:
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qDefaultServerLayout\*q \*q" layout\-id \*q
+This specifies the default
+.B ServerLayout
+section to use in the absence of the
+.B \-layout
+command line option.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qNoTrapSignals\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This prevents the __xservername__ server from trapping a range of unexpected fatal
+signals and exiting cleanly.
+Instead, the __xservername__ server will die and drop core where the fault occurred.
+The default behaviour is for the __xservername__ server to exit cleanly, but still drop a
+core file.
+In general you never want to use this option unless you are debugging an __xservername__
+server problem and know how to deal with the consequences.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qUseSIGIO\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This controls whether the __xservername__ server requests that events from
+input devices be reported via a SIGIO signal handler (also known as SIGPOLL
+on some platforms), or only reported via the standard select(3) loop.
+The default behaviour is platform specific. In general you do not want to
+use this option unless you are debugging the __xservername__ server, or
+working around a specific bug until it is fixed, and understand the
+consequences.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qDontVTSwitch\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This disallows the use of the
+.BI Ctrl+Alt+F n
+sequence (where
+.RI F n
+refers to one of the numbered function keys).
+That sequence is normally used to switch to another \*qvirtual terminal\*q
+on operating systems that have this feature.
+When this option is enabled, that key sequence has no special meaning and
+is passed to clients.
+Default: off.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qDontZap\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This disallows the use of the
+.B Terminate_Server
+XKB action (usually on Ctrl+Alt+Backspace, depending on XKB options).
+This action is normally used to terminate the __xservername__ server.
+When this option is enabled, the action has no effect.
+Default: off.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qDontZoom\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This disallows the use of the
+.B Ctrl+Alt+Keypad\-Plus
+and
+.B Ctrl+Alt+Keypad\-Minus
+sequences.
+These sequences allows you to switch between video modes.
+When this option is enabled, those key sequences have no special meaning
+and are passed to clients.
+Default: off.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qDisableVidModeExtension\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This disables the parts of the VidMode extension used by the xvidtune client
+that can be used to change the video modes.
+Default: the VidMode extension is enabled.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAllowNonLocalXvidtune\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This allows the xvidtune client (and other clients that use the VidMode
+extension) to connect from another host.
+Default: off.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAllowMouseOpenFail\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This tells the mousedrv(__drivermansuffix__) and vmmouse(__drivermansuffix__)
+drivers to not report failure if the mouse device can't be opened/initialised.
+It has no effect on the evdev(__drivermansuffix__) or other drivers.
+Default: false.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qVTSysReq\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+enables the SYSV\-style VT switch sequence for non\-SYSV systems
+which support VT switching.
+This sequence is
+.B Alt\-SysRq
+followed by a function key
+.RB ( Fn ).
+This prevents the __xservername__ server trapping the
+keys used for the default VT switch sequence, which means that clients can
+access them.
+Default: off.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qBlankTime\*q \*q" time \*q
+sets the inactivity timeout for the
+.B blank
+phase of the screensaver.
+.I time
+is in minutes.
+This is equivalent to the __xservername__ server's
+.B \-s
+flag, and the value can be changed at run\-time with
+.BR xset(__appmansuffix__).
+Default: 10 minutes.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qStandbyTime\*q \*q" time \*q
+sets the inactivity timeout for the
+.B standby
+phase of DPMS mode.
+.I time
+is in minutes, and the value can be changed at run\-time with
+.BR xset(__appmansuffix__).
+Default: 10 minutes.
+This is only suitable for VESA DPMS compatible monitors, and may not be
+supported by all video drivers.
+It is only enabled for screens that have the
+.B \*qDPMS\*q
+option set (see the MONITOR section below).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qSuspendTime\*q \*q" time \*q
+sets the inactivity timeout for the
+.B suspend
+phase of DPMS mode.
+.I time
+is in minutes, and the value can be changed at run\-time with
+.BR xset(__appmansuffix__).
+Default: 10 minutes.
+This is only suitable for VESA DPMS compatible monitors, and may not be
+supported by all video drivers.
+It is only enabled for screens that have the
+.B \*qDPMS\*q
+option set (see the MONITOR section below).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qOffTime\*q \*q" time \*q
+sets the inactivity timeout for the
+.B off
+phase of DPMS mode.
+.I time
+is in minutes, and the value can be changed at run\-time with
+.BR xset(__appmansuffix__).
+Default: 10 minutes.
+This is only suitable for VESA DPMS compatible monitors, and may not be
+supported by all video drivers.
+It is only enabled for screens that have the
+.B \*qDPMS\*q
+option set (see the MONITOR section below).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qPixmap\*q \*q" bpp \*q
+This sets the pixmap format to use for depth 24.
+Allowed values for
+.I bpp
+are 24 and 32.
+Default: 32 unless driver constraints don't allow this (which is rare).
+Note: some clients don't behave well when this value is set to 24.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qPC98\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Specify that the machine is a Japanese PC\-98 machine.
+This should not be enabled for anything other than the Japanese\-specific
+PC\-98 architecture.
+Default: auto\-detected.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qNoPM\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Disables something to do with power management events.
+Default: PM enabled on platforms that support it.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXinerama\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+enable or disable XINERAMA extension.
+Default is disabled.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAIGLX\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+enable or disable AIGLX. AIGLX is enabled by default.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qDRI2\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+enable or disable DRI2. DRI2 is disabled by default.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qGlxVisuals\*q \*q" string \*q
+This option controls how many GLX visuals the GLX modules sets up.
+The default value is
+.BR "typical" ,
+which will setup up a typical subset of
+the GLXFBConfigs provided by the driver as GLX visuals. Other options are
+.BR "minimal" ,
+which will set up the minimal set allowed by the GLX specification and
+.BR "all"
+which will setup GLX visuals for all GLXFBConfigs.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qUseDefaultFontPath\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Include the default font path even if other paths are specified in
+xorg.conf. If enabled, other font paths are included as well. Enabled by
+default.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qIgnoreABI\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Allow modules built for a different, potentially incompatible version of
+the X server to load. Disabled by default.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAutoAddDevices\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+If this option is disabled, then no devices will be added from HAL events.
+Enabled by default.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAutoEnableDevices\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+If this option is disabled, then the devices will be added (and the
+DevicePresenceNotify event sent), but not enabled, thus leaving policy up
+to the client.
+Enabled by default.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qLog\*q \*q" string \*q
+This option controls whether the log is flushed and/or synced to disk after
+each message.
+Possible values are
+.B flush
+or
+.BR sync .
+Unset by default.
+.SH "MODULE SECTION"
+The
+.B Module
+section is used to specify which __xservername__ server modules should be loaded.
+This section is ignored when the __xservername__ server is built in static form.
+The type of modules normally loaded in this section are __xservername__ server
+extension modules.
+Most other module types are loaded automatically when they are needed via
+other mechanisms.
+The
+.B Module
+section is optional, as are all of the entries that may be specified in
+it.
+.PP
+Entries in this section may be in two forms.
+The first and most commonly used form is an entry that uses the
+.B Load
+keyword, as described here:
+.TP 7
+.BI "Load \*q" modulename \*q
+This instructs the server to load the module called
+.IR modulename .
+The module name given should be the module's standard name, not the
+module file name.
+The standard name is case\-sensitive, and does not include the \(lqlib\(rq
+prefix, or the \(lq.a\(rq, \(lq.o\(rq, or \(lq.so\(rq suffixes.
+.PP
+.RS 7
+Example: the DRI extension module can be loaded with the following entry:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.B "Load \*qdri\*q"
+.RE
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "Disable \*q" modulename \*q
+This instructs the server to not load the module called
+.IR modulename .
+Some modules are loaded by default in the server, and this overrides that
+default. If a
+.B Load
+instruction is given for the same module, it overrides the
+.B Disable
+instruction and the module is loaded. The module name given should be the
+module's standard name, not the module file name. As with the
+.B Load
+instruction, the standard name is case-sensitive, and does not include the
+"lib" prefix, or the ".a", ".o", or ".so" suffixes.
+.PP
+The second form of entry is a
+.BR SubSection,
+with the subsection name being the module name, and the contents of the
+.B SubSection
+being
+.B Options
+that are passed to the module when it is loaded.
+.PP
+Example: the extmod module (which contains a miscellaneous group of
+server extensions) can be loaded, with the XFree86\-DGA extension
+disabled by using the following entry:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "SubSection \*qextmod\*q"
+.B " Option \*qomit XFree86\-DGA\*q"
+.B EndSubSection
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+Modules are searched for in each directory specified in the
+.B ModulePath
+search path, and in the drivers, extensions, input, internal, and
+multimedia subdirectories of each of those directories.
+In addition to this, operating system specific subdirectories of all
+the above are searched first if they exist.
+.PP
+To see what extension modules are available, check the extensions
+subdirectory under:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+__modulepath__
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The \(lqextmod\(rq, \(lqdbe\(rq, \(lqdri\(rq, \(lqdri2\(rq, \(lqglx\(rq,
+and \(lqrecord\(rq extension modules are loaded automatically, if they
+are present, unless disabled with \*qDisable\*q entries.
+It is recommended
+that at very least the \(lqextmod\(rq extension module be loaded.
+If it isn't, some commonly used server extensions (like the SHAPE
+extension) will not be available.
+.SH "EXTENSIONS SECTION"
+The
+.B Extensions
+section is used to specify which X11 protocol extensions should be enabled
+or disabled.
+The
+.B Extensions
+section is optional, as are all of the entries that may be specified in
+it.
+.PP
+Entries in this section are listed as Option statements with the name of
+the extension as the first argument, and a boolean value as the second.
+The extension name is case\-sensitive, and matches the form shown in the output
+of \*qXorg -extension ?\*q.
+.PP
+.RS 7
+Example: the MIT-SHM extension can be disabled with the following entry:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qExtensions\*q"
+.B " Option \*qMIT-SHM\*q \*qDisable\*q"
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.RE
+.SH "INPUTDEVICE SECTION"
+The config file may have multiple
+.B InputDevice
+sections.
+Recent X servers employ HAL or udev backends for input device enumeration
+and input hotplugging. It is usually not
+necessary to provide
+.B InputDevice
+sections in the xorg.conf if hotplugging is in use. If hotplugging is
+enabled,
+.B InputDevice
+sections using the
+.B mouse, kbd
+and
+.B vmmouse
+driver will be ignored.
+.PP
+If hotplugging is disabled, there will normally
+be at least two: one for the core (primary) keyboard
+and one for the core pointer.
+If either of these two is missing, a default configuration for the missing
+ones will be used. In the absence of an explicitly specified core input
+device, the first
+.B InputDevice
+marked as
+.B CorePointer
+(or
+.BR CoreKeyboard )
+is used.
+If there is no match there, the first
+.B InputDevice
+that uses the \(lqmouse\(rq (or \(lqkbd\(rq) driver is used.
+The final fallback is to use built\-in default configurations.
+Currently the default configuration may not work as expected on all platforms.
+.PP
+.B InputDevice
+sections have the following format:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qInputDevice\*q"
+.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q
+.BI " Driver \*q" inputdriver \*q
+.I " options"
+.I " ..."
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+and
+.B Driver
+entries are required in all
+.B InputDevice
+sections.
+All other entries are optional.
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+entry specifies the unique name for this input device.
+The
+.B Driver
+entry specifies the name of the driver to use for this input device.
+When using the loadable server, the input driver module
+.RI \*q inputdriver \*q
+will be loaded for each active
+.B InputDevice
+section.
+An
+.B InputDevice
+section is considered active if it is referenced by an active
+.B ServerLayout
+section, if it is referenced by the
+.B \-keyboard
+or
+.B \-pointer
+command line options, or if it is selected implicitly as the core pointer
+or keyboard device in the absence of such explicit references.
+The most commonly used input drivers are
+.BR evdev (__drivermansuffix__)
+on Linux systems, and
+.BR kbd (__drivermansuffix__)
+and
+.BR mousedrv (__drivermansuffix__)
+on other platforms.
+.PP
+.PP
+.B InputDevice
+sections recognise some driver\-independent
+.BR Options ,
+which are described here.
+See the individual input driver manual pages for a description of the
+device\-specific options.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAutoServerLayout\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Always add the device to the ServerLayout section used by this instance of
+the server. This affects implied layouts as well as explicit layouts
+specified in the configuration and/or on the command line.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qCorePointer\*q"
+Deprecated, see
+.B Floating
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qCoreKeyboard\*q"
+Deprecated, see
+.B Floating
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAlwaysCore\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Deprecated, see
+.B Floating
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qSendCoreEvents\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Deprecated, see
+.B Floating
+
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qFloating\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+When enabled, the input device is set up floating and does not
+report events through any master device or control a cursor. The device is
+only available to clients using the X Input Extension API. This option is
+disabled by default.
+The options
+.B CorePointer,
+.B CoreKeyboard,
+.B AlwaysCore,
+and
+.B SendCoreEvents,
+are the inverse of option
+.B Floating
+(i.e.
+.B SendCoreEvents \*qon\*q
+is equivalent to
+.B Floating \*qoff\*q
+).
+
+This option controls the startup behavior only, a device
+may be reattached or set floating at runtime.
+.PP
+For pointing devices, the following options control how the pointer
+is accelerated or decelerated with respect to physical device motion. Most of
+these can be adjusted at runtime, see the xinput(1) man page for details. Only
+the most important acceleration options are discussed here.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAccelerationProfile\*q \*q" integer \*q
+Select the profile. In layman's terms, the profile constitutes the "feeling" of
+the acceleration. More formally, it defines how the transfer function (actual
+acceleration as a function of current device velocity and acceleration controls)
+is constructed. This is mainly a matter of personal preference.
+.PP
+.RS 6
+.nf
+.B " 0 classic (mostly compatible)"
+.B "-1 none (only constant deceleration is applied)"
+.B " 1 device-dependent"
+.B " 2 polynomial (polynomial function)"
+.B " 3 smooth linear (soft knee, then linear)"
+.B " 4 simple (normal when slow, otherwise accelerated)"
+.B " 5 power (power function)"
+.B " 6 linear (more speed, more acceleration)"
+.B " 7 limited (like linear, but maxes out at threshold)"
+.fi
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qConstantDeceleration\*q \*q" real \*q
+Makes the pointer go
+.B deceleration
+times slower than normal. Most useful for high-resolution devices.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAdaptiveDeceleration\*q \*q" real \*q
+Allows to actually decelerate the pointer when going slow. At most, it will be
+.B adaptive deceleration
+times slower. Enables precise pointer placement without sacrificing speed.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAccelerationScheme\*q \*q" string \*q
+Selects the scheme, which is the underlying algorithm.
+.PP
+.RS 7
+.nf
+.B "predictable default algorithm (behaving more predictable)"
+.B "lightweight old acceleration code (as specified in the X protocol spec)"
+.B "none no acceleration or deceleration"
+.fi
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAccelerationNumerator\*q \*q" integer \*q
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAccelerationDenominator\*q \*q" integer \*q
+Set numerator and denominator of the acceleration factor. The acceleration
+factor is a rational which, together with threshold, can be used to tweak
+profiles to suit the users needs. The
+.B simple
+and
+.B limited
+profiles use it directly (i.e. they accelerate by the factor), for other
+profiles it should hold that a higher acceleration factor leads to a faster
+pointer. Typically, 1 is unaccelerated and values up to 5 are sensible.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAccelerationThreshold\*q \*q" integer \*q
+Set the threshold, which is roughly the velocity (usually device units per 10
+ms) required for acceleration to become effective. The precise effect varies
+with the profile however.
+
+.SH "INPUTCLASS SECTION"
+The config file may have multiple
+.B InputClass
+sections.
+These sections are optional and are used to provide configuration for a
+class of input devices as they are automatically added. An input device can
+match more than one
+.B InputClass
+section. Each class can override settings from a previous class, so it is
+best to arrange the sections with the most generic matches first.
+.PP
+.B InputClass
+sections have the following format:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qInputClass\*q"
+.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q
+.I " entries"
+.I " ..."
+.I " options"
+.I " ..."
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+entry is required in all
+.B InputClass
+sections.
+All other entries are optional.
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+entry specifies the unique name for this input class.
+The
+.B Driver
+entry specifies the name of the driver to use for this input device.
+After all classes have been examined, the
+.RI \*q inputdriver \*q
+module from the first
+.B Driver
+entry will be enabled when using the loadable server.
+.PP
+When an input device is automatically added, its characteristics are
+checked against all
+.B InputClass
+sections. Each section can contain optional entries to narrow the match
+of the class. If none of the optional entries appear, the
+.B InputClass
+section is generic and will match any input device. If more than one of
+these entries appear, they all must match for the configuration to apply.
+.PP
+There are two types of match entries used in
+.B InputClass
+sections. The first allows various tokens to be matched against attributes
+of the device. An entry can be constructed to match attributes from different
+devices by separating arguments with a '|' character. Multiple entries of the
+same type may be supplied to add multiple matching conditions on the same
+attribute. For example:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qInputClass\*q"
+.B " Identifier \*qMy Class\*q"
+.B " # product string must contain example and
+.B " # either gizmo or gadget
+.B " MatchProduct \*qexample\*q
+.B " MatchProduct \*qgizmo|gadget\*q
+.I " ..."
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchProduct \*q" matchproduct \*q
+This entry can be used to check if the substring
+.RI \*q matchproduct \*q
+occurs in the device's product name.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchVendor \*q" matchvendor \*q
+This entry can be used to check if the substring
+.RI \*q matchvendor \*q
+occurs in the device's vendor name.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchDevicePath \*q" matchdevice \*q
+This entry can be used to check if the device file matches the
+.RI \*q matchdevice \*q
+pathname pattern.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchOS \*q" matchos \*q
+This entry can be used to check if the operating system matches the
+case-insensitive
+.RI \*q matchos \*q
+string. This entry is only supported on platforms providing the
+.BR uname (2)
+system call.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchPnPID \*q" matchpnp \*q
+The device's Plug and Play (PnP) ID can be checked against the
+.RI \*q matchpnp \*q
+shell wildcard pattern.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchUSBID \*q" matchusb \*q
+The device's USB ID can be checked against the
+.RI \*q matchusb \*q
+shell wildcard pattern. The ID is constructed as lowercase hexadecimal numbers
+separated by a ':'. This is the same format as the
+.BR lsusb (8)
+program.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchDriver \*q" matchdriver \*q
+Check the case-sensitive string
+.RI \*q matchdriver \*q
+against the currently configured driver of the device. Ordering of sections
+using this entry is important since it will not match unless the driver has
+been set by the config backend or a previous
+.B InputClass
+section.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchTag \*q" matchtag \*q
+This entry can be used to check if tags assigned by the config backend
+matches the
+.RI \*q matchtag \*q
+pattern. A match is found if at least one of the tags given in
+.RI \*q matchtag \*q
+matches at least one of the tags assigned by the backend.
+.PP
+The second type of entry is used to match device types. These entries take a
+boolean argument similar to
+.B Option
+entries.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchIsKeyboard \*q" bool \*q
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchIsPointer \*q" bool \*q
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchIsJoystick \*q" bool \*q
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchIsTablet \*q" bool \*q
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchIsTouchpad \*q" bool \*q
+.TP 7
+.BI "MatchIsTouchscreen \*q" bool \*q
+.PP
+When an input device has been matched to the
+.B InputClass
+section, any
+.B Option
+entries are applied to the device. One
+.B InputClass
+specific
+.B Option
+is recognized. See the
+.B InputDevice
+section above for a description of the remaining
+.B Option
+entries.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qIgnore\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+This optional entry specifies that the device should be ignored entirely,
+and not added to the server. This can be useful when the device is handled
+by another program and no X events should be generated.
+.SH "DEVICE SECTION"
+The config file may have multiple
+.B Device
+sections.
+There must be at least one, for the video card being used.
+.PP
+.B Device
+sections have the following format:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qDevice\*q"
+.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q
+.BI " Driver \*q" driver \*q
+.I " entries"
+.I " ..."
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+and
+.B Driver
+entries are required in all
+.B Device
+sections. All other entries are optional.
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+entry specifies the unique name for this graphics device.
+The
+.B Driver
+entry specifies the name of the driver to use for this graphics device.
+When using the loadable server, the driver module
+.RI \*q driver \*q
+will be loaded for each active
+.B Device
+section.
+A
+.B Device
+section is considered active if it is referenced by an active
+.B Screen
+section.
+.PP
+.B Device
+sections recognise some driver\-independent entries and
+.BR Options ,
+which are described here.
+Not all drivers make use of these
+driver\-independent entries, and many of those that do don't require them
+to be specified because the information is auto\-detected.
+See the individual graphics driver manual pages for further information
+about this, and for a description of the device\-specific options.
+Note that most of the
+.B Options
+listed here (but not the other entries) may be specified in the
+.B Screen
+section instead of here in the
+.B Device
+section.
+.TP 7
+.BI "BusID \*q" bus\-id \*q
+This specifies the bus location of the graphics card.
+For PCI/AGP cards,
+the
+.I bus\-id
+string has the form
+.BI PCI: bus : device : function
+(e.g., \(lqPCI:1:0:0\(rq might be appropriate for an AGP card).
+This field is usually optional in single-head configurations when using
+the primary graphics card.
+In multi-head configurations, or when using a secondary graphics card in a
+single-head configuration, this entry is mandatory.
+Its main purpose is to make an unambiguous connection between the device
+section and the hardware it is representing.
+This information can usually be found by running the pciaccess tool
+scanpci.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Screen " number
+This option is mandatory for cards where a single PCI entity can drive more
+than one display (i.e., multiple CRTCs sharing a single graphics accelerator
+and video memory).
+One
+.B Device
+section is required for each head, and this
+parameter determines which head each of the
+.B Device
+sections applies to.
+The legal values of
+.I number
+range from 0 to one less than the total number of heads per entity.
+Most drivers require that the primary screen (0) be present.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Chipset \*q" chipset \*q
+This usually optional entry specifies the chipset used on the graphics
+board.
+In most cases this entry is not required because the drivers will probe the
+hardware to determine the chipset type.
+Don't specify it unless the driver-specific documentation recommends that you
+do.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Ramdac \*q" ramdac\-type \*q
+This optional entry specifies the type of RAMDAC used on the graphics
+board.
+This is only used by a few of the drivers, and in most cases it is not
+required because the drivers will probe the hardware to determine the
+RAMDAC type where possible.
+Don't specify it unless the driver-specific documentation recommends that you
+do.
+.TP 7
+.BI "DacSpeed " speed
+.TP 7
+.BI "DacSpeed " "speed\-8 speed\-16 speed\-24 speed\-32"
+This optional entry specifies the RAMDAC speed rating (which is usually
+printed on the RAMDAC chip).
+The speed is in MHz.
+When one value is given, it applies to all framebuffer pixel sizes.
+When multiple values are given, they apply to the framebuffer pixel sizes
+8, 16, 24 and 32 respectively.
+This is not used by many drivers, and only needs to be specified when the
+speed rating of the RAMDAC is different from the defaults built in to
+driver, or when the driver can't auto-detect the correct defaults.
+Don't specify it unless the driver-specific documentation recommends that you
+do.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Clocks " "clock ..."
+specifies the pixel that are on your graphics board.
+The clocks are in MHz, and may be specified as a floating point number.
+The value is stored internally to the nearest kHz.
+The ordering of the clocks is important.
+It must match the order in which they are selected on the graphics board.
+Multiple
+.B Clocks
+lines may be specified, and each is concatenated to form the list.
+Most drivers do not use this entry, and it is only required for some older
+boards with non-programmable clocks.
+Don't specify this entry unless the driver-specific documentation explicitly
+recommends that you do.
+.TP
+.BI "ClockChip \*q" clockchip\-type \*q
+This optional entry is used to specify the clock chip type on graphics
+boards which have a programmable clock generator.
+Only a few __xservername__ drivers support programmable clock chips.
+For details, see the appropriate driver manual page.
+.TP 7
+.BI "VideoRam " "mem"
+This optional entry specifies the amount of video ram that is installed
+on the graphics board.
+This is measured in kBytes.
+In most cases this is not required because the __xservername__ server probes
+the graphics board to determine this quantity.
+The driver-specific documentation should indicate when it might be needed.
+.TP 7
+.BI "BiosBase " "baseaddress"
+This optional entry specifies the base address of the video BIOS for
+the VGA board.
+This address is normally auto-detected, and should only be specified if the
+driver-specific documentation recommends it.
+.TP 7
+.BI "MemBase " "baseaddress"
+This optional entry specifies the memory base address of a graphics
+board's linear frame buffer.
+This entry is not used by many drivers, and it should only be specified if
+the driver-specific documentation recommends it.
+.TP 7
+.BI "IOBase " "baseaddress"
+This optional entry specifies the IO base address.
+This entry is not used by many drivers, and it should only be specified if
+the driver-specific documentation recommends it.
+.TP 7
+.BI "ChipID " "id"
+This optional entry specifies a numerical ID representing the chip type.
+For PCI cards, it is usually the device ID.
+This can be used to override the auto-detection, but that should only be done
+when the driver-specific documentation recommends it.
+.TP 7
+.BI "ChipRev " "rev"
+This optional entry specifies the chip revision number.
+This can be used to override the auto-detection, but that should only be done
+when the driver-specific documentation recommends it.
+.TP 7
+.BI "TextClockFreq " "freq"
+This optional entry specifies the pixel clock frequency that is used
+for the regular text mode.
+The frequency is specified in MHz.
+This is rarely used.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qModeDebug\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Enable printing of additional debugging information about modesetting to
+the server log.
+.ig
+.TP 7
+This optional entry allows an IRQ number to be specified.
+..
+.TP 7
+.B Options
+Option flags may be specified in the
+.B Device
+sections.
+These include driver\-specific options and driver\-independent options.
+The former are described in the driver\-specific documentation.
+Some of the latter are described below in the section about the
+.B Screen
+section, and they may also be included here.
+
+.SH "VIDEOADAPTOR SECTION"
+Nobody wants to say how this works.
+Maybe nobody knows ...
+
+.SH "MONITOR SECTION"
+The config file may have multiple
+.B Monitor
+sections.
+There should normally be at least one, for the monitor being used,
+but a default configuration will be created when one isn't specified.
+.PP
+.B Monitor
+sections have the following format:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qMonitor\*q"
+.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q
+.I " entries"
+.I " ..."
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The only mandatory entry in a
+.B Monitor
+section is the
+.B Identifier
+entry.
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+entry specifies the unique name for this monitor.
+The
+.B Monitor
+section may be used to provide information about the specifications of the
+monitor, monitor-specific
+.BR Options ,
+and information about the video modes to use with the monitor.
+.PP
+With RandR 1.2-enabled drivers, monitor sections may be tied to specific
+outputs of the video card. Using the name of the output defined by the video
+driver plus the identifier of a monitor section, one associates a monitor
+section with an output by adding an option to the Device section in the
+following format:
+
+.B Option \*qMonitor-outputname\*q \*qmonitorsection\*q
+
+(for example,
+.B Option \*qMonitor-VGA\*q \*qVGA monitor\*q
+for a VGA output)
+.PP
+In the absence of specific association of monitor sections to outputs, if a
+monitor section is present the server will associate it with an output to
+preserve compatibility for previous single-head configurations.
+.PP
+Specifying video modes is optional because the server will use the DDC or other
+information provided by the monitor to automatically configure the list of
+modes available.
+When modes are specified explicitly in the
+.B Monitor
+section (with the
+.BR Modes ,
+.BR ModeLine ,
+or
+.B UseModes
+keywords), built-in modes with the same names are not included.
+Built-in modes with different names are, however, still implicitly included,
+when they meet the requirements of the monitor.
+.PP
+The entries that may be used in
+.B Monitor
+sections are described below.
+.TP 7
+.BI "VendorName \*q" vendor \*q
+This optional entry specifies the monitor's manufacturer.
+.TP 7
+.BI "ModelName \*q" model \*q
+This optional entry specifies the monitor's model.
+.TP 7
+.BI "HorizSync " "horizsync\-range"
+gives the range(s) of horizontal sync frequencies supported by the
+monitor.
+.I horizsync\-range
+may be a comma separated list of either discrete values or ranges of
+values.
+A range of values is two values separated by a dash.
+By default the values are in units of kHz.
+They may be specified in MHz or Hz
+if
+.B MHz
+or
+.B Hz
+is added to the end of the line.
+The data given here is used by the __xservername__ server to determine if video
+modes are within the specifications of the monitor.
+This information should be available in the monitor's handbook.
+If this entry is omitted, a default range of 28\-33kHz is used.
+.TP 7
+.BI "VertRefresh " "vertrefresh\-range"
+gives the range(s) of vertical refresh frequencies supported by the
+monitor.
+.I vertrefresh\-range
+may be a comma separated list of either discrete values or ranges of
+values.
+A range of values is two values separated by a dash.
+By default the values are in units of Hz.
+They may be specified in MHz or kHz
+if
+.B MHz
+or
+.B kHz
+is added to the end of the line.
+The data given here is used by the __xservername__ server to determine if video
+modes are within the specifications of the monitor.
+This information should be available in the monitor's handbook.
+If this entry is omitted, a default range of 43\-72Hz is used.
+.TP 7
+.BI "DisplaySize " "width height"
+This optional entry gives the width and height, in millimetres, of the
+picture area of the monitor.
+If given this is used to calculate the horizontal and vertical pitch (DPI) of
+the screen.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Gamma " "gamma\-value"
+.TP 7
+.BI "Gamma " "red\-gamma green\-gamma blue\-gamma"
+This is an optional entry that can be used to specify the gamma correction
+for the monitor.
+It may be specified as either a single value or as three separate RGB values.
+The values should be in the range 0.1 to 10.0, and the default is 1.0.
+Not all drivers are capable of using this information.
+.TP 7
+.BI "UseModes \*q" modesection\-id \*q
+Include the set of modes listed in the
+.B Modes
+section called
+.IR modesection\-id.
+This makes all of the modes defined in that section available for use by
+this monitor.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Mode \*q" name \*q
+This is an optional multi-line entry that can be used to provide
+definitions for video modes for the monitor.
+In most cases this isn't necessary because the built-in set of VESA standard
+modes will be sufficient.
+The
+.B Mode
+keyword indicates the start of a multi-line video mode description.
+The mode description is terminated with the
+.B EndMode
+keyword.
+The mode description consists of the following entries:
+.RS 7
+.TP 4
+.BI "DotClock " clock
+is the dot (pixel) clock rate to be used for the mode.
+.TP 4
+.BI "HTimings " "hdisp hsyncstart hsyncend htotal"
+specifies the horizontal timings for the mode.
+.TP 4
+.BI "VTimings " "vdisp vsyncstart vsyncend vtotal"
+specifies the vertical timings for the mode.
+.TP 4
+.BI "Flags \*q" flag \*q " ..."
+specifies an optional set of mode flags, each of which is a separate
+string in double quotes.
+.B \*qInterlace\*q
+indicates that the mode is interlaced.
+.B \*qDoubleScan\*q
+indicates a mode where each scanline is doubled.
+.B \*q+HSync\*q
+and
+.B \*q\-HSync\*q
+can be used to select the polarity of the HSync signal.
+.B \*q+VSync\*q
+and
+.B \*q\-VSync\*q
+can be used to select the polarity of the VSync signal.
+.B \*qComposite\*q
+can be used to specify composite sync on hardware where this is supported.
+Additionally, on some hardware,
+.B \*q+CSync\*q
+and
+.B \*q\-CSync\*q
+may be used to select the composite sync polarity.
+.TP 4
+.BI "HSkew " hskew
+specifies the number of pixels (towards the right edge of the screen) by
+which the display enable signal is to be skewed.
+Not all drivers use this information.
+This option might become necessary to override the default value supplied
+by the server (if any).
+\(lqRoving\(rq horizontal lines indicate this value needs to be increased.
+If the last few pixels on a scan line appear on the left of the screen,
+this value should be decreased.
+.TP 4
+.BI "VScan " vscan
+specifies the number of times each scanline is painted on the screen.
+Not all drivers use this information.
+Values less than 1 are treated as 1, which is the default.
+Generally, the
+.B \*qDoubleScan\*q
+.B Flag
+mentioned above doubles this value.
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "ModeLine \*q" name \*q " mode\-description"
+This entry is a more compact version of the
+.B Mode
+entry, and it also can be used to specify video modes for the monitor.
+is a single line format for specifying video modes.
+In most cases this isn't necessary because the built\-in set of VESA
+standard modes will be sufficient.
+.PP
+.RS 7
+The
+.I mode\-description
+is in four sections, the first three of which are mandatory.
+The first is the dot (pixel) clock.
+This is a single number specifying the pixel clock rate for the mode in
+MHz.
+The second section is a list of four numbers specifying the horizontal
+timings.
+These numbers are the
+.IR hdisp ,
+.IR hsyncstart ,
+.IR hsyncend ,
+and
+.I htotal
+values.
+The third section is a list of four numbers specifying the vertical
+timings.
+These numbers are the
+.IR vdisp ,
+.IR vsyncstart ,
+.IR vsyncend ,
+and
+.I vtotal
+values.
+The final section is a list of flags specifying other characteristics of
+the mode.
+.B Interlace
+indicates that the mode is interlaced.
+.B DoubleScan
+indicates a mode where each scanline is doubled.
+.B +HSync
+and
+.B \-HSync
+can be used to select the polarity of the HSync signal.
+.B +VSync
+and
+.B \-VSync
+can be used to select the polarity of the VSync signal.
+.B Composite
+can be used to specify composite sync on hardware where this is supported.
+Additionally, on some hardware,
+.B +CSync
+and
+.B \-CSync
+may be used to select the composite sync polarity.
+The
+.B HSkew
+and
+.B VScan
+options mentioned above in the
+.B Modes
+entry description can also be used here.
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qDPMS\*q " \*qbool\*q
+This option controls whether the server should enable the DPMS extension
+for power management for this screen. The default is to enable the
+extension.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qSyncOnGreen\*q " \*qbool\*q
+This option controls whether the video card should drive the sync signal
+on the green color pin. Not all cards support this option, and most
+monitors do not require it. The default is off.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qPrimary\*q " \*qbool\*q
+This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be treated as the primary
+monitor. (RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qPreferredMode\*q " \*qstring\*q
+This optional entry specifies a mode to be marked as the preferred initial mode
+of the monitor.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qPosition\*q " "\*qx y\*q"
+This optional entry specifies the position of the monitor within the X
+screen.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qLeftOf\*q " \*qoutput\*q
+This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be positioned to the
+left of the output (not monitor) of the given name.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qRightOf\*q " \*qoutput\*q
+This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be positioned to the
+right of the output (not monitor) of the given name.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qAbove\*q " \*qoutput\*q
+This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be positioned above the
+output (not monitor) of the given name.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qBelow\*q " \*qoutput\*q
+This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be positioned below the
+output (not monitor) of the given name.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qEnable\*q " \*qbool\*q
+This optional entry specifies whether the monitor should be turned on
+at startup. By default, the server will attempt to enable all connected
+monitors.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qDefaultModes\*q " \*qbool\*q
+This optional entry specifies whether the server should add supported default
+modes to the list of modes offered on this monitor. By default, the server
+will add default modes; you should only disable this if you can guarantee
+that EDID will be available at all times, or if you have added custom modelines
+which the server can use.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qMinClock\*q " \*qfrequency\*q
+This optional entry specifies the minimum dot clock, in kHz, that is supported
+by the monitor.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qMaxClock\*q " \*qfrequency\*q
+This optional entry specifies the maximum dot clock, in kHz, that is supported
+by the monitor.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qIgnore\*q " \*qbool\*q
+This optional entry specifies that the monitor should be ignored entirely,
+and not reported through RandR. This is useful if the hardware reports the
+presence of outputs that don't exist.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option " "\*qRotate\*q " \*qrotation\*q
+This optional entry specifies the initial rotation of the given monitor.
+Valid values for rotation are \*qnormal\*q, \*qleft\*q, \*qright\*q, and
+\*qinverted\*q.
+(RandR 1.2-supporting drivers only)
+
+.SH "MODES SECTION"
+The config file may have multiple
+.B Modes
+sections, or none.
+These sections provide a way of defining sets of video modes independently
+of the
+.B Monitor
+sections.
+.B Monitor
+sections may include the definitions provided in these sections by
+using the
+.B UseModes
+keyword.
+In most cases the
+.B Modes
+sections are not necessary because the built\-in set of VESA standard modes
+will be sufficient.
+.PP
+.B Modes
+sections have the following format:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qModes\*q"
+.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q
+.I " entries"
+.I " ..."
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+entry specifies the unique name for this set of mode descriptions.
+The other entries permitted in
+.B Modes
+sections are the
+.B Mode
+and
+.B ModeLine
+entries that are described above in the
+.B Monitor
+section.
+.SH "SCREEN SECTION"
+The config file may have multiple
+.B Screen
+sections.
+There must be at least one, for the \(lqscreen\(rq being used.
+A \(lqscreen\(rq represents the binding of a graphics device
+.RB ( Device
+section) and a monitor
+.RB ( Monitor
+section).
+A
+.B Screen
+section is considered \(lqactive\(rq if it is referenced by an active
+.B ServerLayout
+section or by the
+.B \-screen
+command line option.
+If neither of those is present, the first
+.B Screen
+section found in the config file is considered the active one.
+.PP
+.B Screen
+sections have the following format:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qScreen\*q"
+.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q
+.BI " Device \*q" devid \*q
+.BI " Monitor \*q" monid \*q
+.I " entries"
+.I " ..."
+.BI " SubSection \*qDisplay\*q"
+.I " entries"
+.I " ...
+.B " EndSubSection"
+.I " ..."
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+and
+.B Device
+entries are mandatory.
+All others are optional.
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+entry specifies the unique name for this screen.
+The
+.B Screen
+section provides information specific to the whole screen, including
+screen\-specific
+.BR Options .
+In multi\-head configurations, there will be multiple active
+.B Screen
+sections, one for each head.
+The entries available
+for this section are:
+.TP 7
+.BI "Device \*q" device\-id \*q
+This mandatory entry specifies the
+.B Device
+section to be used for this screen.
+This is what ties a specific graphics card to a screen.
+The
+.I device\-id
+must match the
+.B Identifier
+of a
+.B Device
+section in the config file.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Monitor \*q" monitor\-id \*q
+specifies which monitor description is to be used for this screen.
+If a
+.B Monitor
+name is not specified, a default configuration is used.
+Currently the default configuration may not function as expected on all
+platforms.
+.TP 7
+.BI "VideoAdaptor \*q" xv\-id \*q
+specifies an optional Xv video adaptor description to be used with this
+screen.
+.TP 7
+.BI "DefaultDepth " depth
+specifies which color depth the server should use by default.
+The
+.B \-depth
+command line option can be used to override this.
+If neither is specified, the default depth is driver\-specific, but in most
+cases is 8.
+.TP 7
+.BI "DefaultFbBpp " bpp
+specifies which framebuffer layout to use by default.
+The
+.B \-fbbpp
+command line option can be used to override this.
+In most cases the driver will chose the best default value for this.
+The only case where there is even a choice in this value is for depth 24,
+where some hardware supports both a packed 24 bit framebuffer layout and a
+sparse 32 bit framebuffer layout.
+.TP 7
+.B Options
+Various
+.B Option
+flags may be specified in the
+.B Screen
+section.
+Some are driver\-specific and are described in the driver documentation.
+Others are driver\-independent, and will eventually be described here.
+.\" XXX These should really be in an xaa man page.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qAccel\*q"
+Enables XAA (X Acceleration Architecture), a mechanism that makes video cards'
+2D hardware acceleration available to the __xservername__ server.
+This option is on by default, but it may be necessary to turn it off if
+there are bugs in the driver.
+There are many options to disable specific accelerated operations, listed
+below.
+Note that disabling an operation will have no effect if the operation is
+not accelerated (whether due to lack of support in the hardware or in the
+driver).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qInitPrimary\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Use the Int10 module to initialize the primary graphics card.
+Normally, only secondary cards are soft-booted using the Int10 module, as the
+primary card has already been initialized by the BIOS at boot time.
+Default: false.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qNoInt10\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+Disables the Int10 module, a module that uses the int10 call to the BIOS
+of the graphics card to initialize it.
+Default: false.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qNoMTRR\*q"
+Disables MTRR (Memory Type Range Register) support, a feature of modern
+processors which can improve video performance by a factor of up to 2.5.
+Some hardware has buggy MTRR support, and some video drivers have been
+known to exhibit problems when MTRR's are used.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoCPUToScreenColorExpandFill\*q"
+Disables accelerated rectangular expansion blits from source patterns
+stored in system memory (using a memory\-mapped aperture).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoColor8x8PatternFillRect\*q"
+Disables accelerated fills of a rectangular region with a full\-color
+pattern.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoColor8x8PatternFillTrap\*q"
+Disables accelerated fills of a trapezoidal region with a full\-color
+pattern.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoDashedBresenhamLine\*q"
+Disables accelerated dashed Bresenham line draws.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoDashedTwoPointLine\*q"
+Disables accelerated dashed line draws between two arbitrary points.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoImageWriteRect\*q"
+Disables accelerated transfers of full\-color rectangular patterns from
+system memory to video memory (using a memory\-mapped aperture).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoMono8x8PatternFillRect\*q"
+Disables accelerated fills of a rectangular region with a monochrome
+pattern.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoMono8x8PatternFillTrap\*q"
+Disables accelerated fills of a trapezoidal region with a monochrome
+pattern.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoOffscreenPixmaps\*q"
+Disables accelerated draws into pixmaps stored in offscreen video memory.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoPixmapCache\*q"
+Disables caching of patterns in offscreen video memory.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoScanlineCPUToScreenColorExpandFill\*q"
+Disables accelerated rectangular expansion blits from source patterns
+stored in system memory (one scan line at a time).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoScanlineImageWriteRect\*q"
+Disables accelerated transfers of full\-color rectangular patterns from
+system memory to video memory (one scan line at a time).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoScreenToScreenColorExpandFill\*q"
+Disables accelerated rectangular expansion blits from source patterns
+stored in offscreen video memory.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoScreenToScreenCopy\*q"
+Disables accelerated copies of rectangular regions from one part of
+video memory to another part of video memory.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidBresenhamLine\*q"
+Disables accelerated solid Bresenham line draws.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidFillRect\*q"
+Disables accelerated solid\-color fills of rectangles.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidFillTrap\*q"
+Disables accelerated solid\-color fills of Bresenham trapezoids.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidHorVertLine\*q"
+Disables accelerated solid horizontal and vertical line draws.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qXaaNoSolidTwoPointLine\*q"
+Disables accelerated solid line draws between two arbitrary points.
+.PP
+Each
+.B Screen
+section may optionally contain one or more
+.B Display
+subsections.
+Those subsections provide depth/fbbpp specific configuration information,
+and the one chosen depends on the depth and/or fbbpp that is being used for
+the screen.
+The
+.B Display
+subsection format is described in the section below.
+
+.SH "DISPLAY SUBSECTION"
+Each
+.B Screen
+section may have multiple
+.B Display
+subsections.
+The \(lqactive\(rq
+.B Display
+subsection is the first that matches the depth and/or fbbpp values being
+used, or failing that, the first that has neither a depth or fbbpp value
+specified.
+The
+.B Display
+subsections are optional.
+When there isn't one that matches the depth and/or fbbpp values being used,
+all the parameters that can be specified here fall back to their defaults.
+.PP
+.B Display
+subsections have the following format:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B " SubSection \*qDisplay\*q"
+.BI " Depth " depth
+.I " entries"
+.I " ..."
+.B " EndSubSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "Depth " depth
+This entry specifies what colour depth the
+.B Display
+subsection is to be used for.
+This entry is usually specified, but it may be omitted to create a match\-all
+.B Display
+subsection or when wishing to match only against the
+.B FbBpp
+parameter.
+The range of
+.I depth
+values that are allowed depends on the driver.
+Most drivers support 8, 15, 16 and 24.
+Some also support 1 and/or 4, and some may support other values (like 30).
+Note:
+.I depth
+means the number of bits in a pixel that are actually used to determine
+the pixel colour.
+32 is not a valid
+.I depth
+value.
+Most hardware that uses 32 bits per pixel only uses 24 of them to hold the
+colour information, which means that the colour depth is 24, not 32.
+.TP 7
+.BI "FbBpp " bpp
+This entry specifies the framebuffer format this
+.B Display
+subsection is to be used for.
+This entry is only needed when providing depth 24 configurations that allow
+a choice between a 24 bpp packed framebuffer format and a 32bpp sparse
+framebuffer format.
+In most cases this entry should not be used.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Weight " "red\-weight green\-weight blue\-weight"
+This optional entry specifies the relative RGB weighting to be used
+for a screen is being used at depth 16 for drivers that allow multiple
+formats.
+This may also be specified from the command line with the
+.B \-weight
+option (see
+.BR __xservername__(__appmansuffix__)).
+.TP 7
+.BI "Virtual " "xdim ydim"
+This optional entry specifies the virtual screen resolution to be used.
+.I xdim
+must be a multiple of either 8 or 16 for most drivers, and a multiple
+of 32 when running in monochrome mode.
+The given value will be rounded down if this is not the case.
+Video modes which are too large for the specified virtual size will be
+rejected.
+If this entry is not present, the virtual screen resolution will be set to
+accommodate all the valid video modes given in the
+.B Modes
+entry.
+Some drivers/hardware combinations do not support virtual screens.
+Refer to the appropriate driver\-specific documentation for details.
+.TP 7
+.BI "ViewPort " "x0 y0"
+This optional entry sets the upper left corner of the initial display.
+This is only relevant when the virtual screen resolution is different
+from the resolution of the initial video mode.
+If this entry is not given, then the initial display will be centered in
+the virtual display area.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Modes \*q" mode\-name \*q " ..."
+This optional entry specifies the list of video modes to use.
+Each
+.I mode\-name
+specified must be in double quotes.
+They must correspond to those specified or referenced in the appropriate
+.B Monitor
+section (including implicitly referenced built\-in VESA standard modes).
+The server will delete modes from this list which don't satisfy various
+requirements.
+The first valid mode in this list will be the default display mode for
+startup.
+The list of valid modes is converted internally into a circular list.
+It is possible to switch to the next mode with
+.B Ctrl+Alt+Keypad\-Plus
+and to the previous mode with
+.BR Ctrl+Alt+Keypad\-Minus .
+When this entry is omitted, the valid modes referenced by the appropriate
+.B Monitor
+section will be used. If the
+.B Monitor
+section contains no modes, then the selection will be taken from the
+built-in VESA standard modes.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Visual \*q" visual\-name \*q
+This optional entry sets the default root visual type.
+This may also be specified from the command line (see the
+.BR Xserver(__appmansuffix__)
+man page).
+The visual types available for depth 8 are (default is
+.BR PseudoColor ):
+.PP
+.RS 11
+.nf
+.B StaticGray
+.B GrayScale
+.B StaticColor
+.B PseudoColor
+.B TrueColor
+.B DirectColor
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+.RS 7
+The visual type available for the depths 15, 16 and 24 are (default is
+.BR TrueColor ):
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B TrueColor
+.B DirectColor
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+Not all drivers support
+.B DirectColor
+at these depths.
+.PP
+The visual types available for the depth 4 are (default is
+.BR StaticColor ):
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B StaticGray
+.B GrayScale
+.B StaticColor
+.B PseudoColor
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+The visual type available for the depth 1 (monochrome) is
+.BR StaticGray .
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "Black " "red green blue"
+This optional entry allows the \(lqblack\(rq colour to be specified.
+This is only supported at depth 1.
+The default is black.
+.TP 7
+.BI "White " "red green blue"
+This optional entry allows the \(lqwhite\(rq colour to be specified.
+This is only supported at depth 1.
+The default is white.
+.TP 7
+.B Options
+Option flags may be specified in the
+.B Display
+subsections.
+These may include driver\-specific options and driver\-independent options.
+The former are described in the driver\-specific documentation.
+Some of the latter are described above in the section about the
+.B Screen
+section, and they may also be included here.
+.SH "SERVERLAYOUT SECTION"
+The config file may have multiple
+.B ServerLayout
+sections.
+A \(lqserver layout\(rq represents the binding of one or more screens
+.RB ( Screen
+sections) and one or more input devices
+.RB ( InputDevice
+sections) to form a complete configuration.
+In multi\-head configurations, it also specifies the relative layout of the
+heads.
+A
+.B ServerLayout
+section is considered \(lqactive\(rq if it is referenced by the
+.B \-layout
+command line option or by an
+.B "Option \*qDefaultServerLayout\*q"
+entry in the
+.B ServerFlags
+section (the former takes precedence over the latter).
+If those options are not used, the first
+.B ServerLayout
+section found in the config file is considered the active one.
+If no
+.B ServerLayout
+sections are present, the single active screen and two active (core)
+input devices are selected as described in the relevant sections above.
+.PP
+.B ServerLayout
+sections have the following format:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qServerLayout\*q"
+.BI " Identifier \*q" name \*q
+.BI " Screen \*q" screen\-id \*q
+.I " ..."
+.BI " InputDevice \*q" idev\-id \*q
+.I " ..."
+.I " options"
+.I " ..."
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+Each
+.B ServerLayout
+section must have an
+.B Identifier
+entry and at least one
+.B Screen
+entry.
+.PP
+The
+.B Identifier
+entry specifies the unique name for this server layout.
+The
+.B ServerLayout
+section provides information specific to the whole session, including
+session\-specific
+.BR Options .
+The
+.B ServerFlags
+options (described above) may be specified here, and ones given here
+override those given in the
+.B ServerFlags
+section.
+.PP
+The entries that may be used in this section are described here.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Screen " "screen\-num" " \*qscreen\-id\*q " "position\-information"
+One of these entries must be given for each screen being used in
+a session.
+The
+.I screen\-id
+field is mandatory, and specifies the
+.B Screen
+section being referenced.
+The
+.I screen\-num
+field is optional, and may be used to specify the screen number
+in multi\-head configurations.
+When this field is omitted, the screens will be numbered in the order that
+they are listed in.
+The numbering starts from 0, and must be consecutive.
+The
+.I position\-information
+field describes the way multiple screens are positioned.
+There are a number of different ways that this information can be provided:
+.RS 7
+.TP 4
+.I "x y"
+.TP 4
+.BI "Absolute " "x y"
+These both specify that the upper left corner's coordinates are
+.RI ( x , y ).
+The
+.B Absolute
+keyword is optional.
+Some older versions of XFree86 (4.2 and earlier) don't recognise the
+.B Absolute
+keyword, so it's safest to just specify the coordinates without it.
+.TP 4
+.BI "RightOf \*q" screen\-id \*q
+.TP 4
+.BI "LeftOf \*q" screen\-id \*q
+.TP 4
+.BI "Above \*q" screen\-id \*q
+.TP 4
+.BI "Below \*q" screen\-id \*q
+.TP 4
+.BI "Relative \*q" screen\-id \*q " x y"
+These give the screen's location relative to another screen.
+The first four position the screen immediately to the right, left, above or
+below the other screen.
+When positioning to the right or left, the top edges are aligned.
+When positioning above or below, the left edges are aligned.
+The
+.B Relative
+form specifies the offset of the screen's origin (upper left corner)
+relative to the origin of another screen.
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.BI "InputDevice \*q" idev\-id "\*q \*q" option \*q " ..."
+One of these entries should be given for each input device being used in
+a session.
+Normally at least two are required, one each for the core pointer and
+keyboard devices.
+If either of those is missing, suitable
+.B InputDevice
+entries are searched for using the method described above in the
+.B INPUTDEVICE
+section. The
+.I idev\-id
+field is mandatory, and specifies the name of the
+.B InputDevice
+section being referenced.
+Multiple
+.I option
+fields may be specified, each in double quotes.
+The options permitted here are any that may also be given in the
+.B InputDevice
+sections.
+Normally only session\-specific input device options would be used here.
+The most commonly used options are:
+.PP
+.RS 11
+.nf
+.B \*qCorePointer\*q
+.B \*qCoreKeyboard\*q
+.B \*qSendCoreEvents\*q
+.fi
+.RE
+.PP
+.RS 7
+and the first two should normally be used to indicate the core pointer
+and core keyboard devices respectively.
+.RE
+.TP 7
+.B Options
+In addition to the following, any option permitted in the
+.B ServerFlags
+section may also be specified here.
+When the same option appears in both places, the value given here overrides
+the one given in the
+.B ServerFlags
+section.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qIsolateDevice\*q \*q" bus\-id \*q
+Restrict device resets to the specified
+.IR bus\-id .
+See the
+.B BusID
+option (described in
+.BR "DEVICE SECTION" ,
+above) for the format of the
+.I bus\-id
+parameter.
+This option overrides
+.BR SingleCard ,
+if specified.
+At present, only PCI devices can be isolated in this manner.
+.TP 7
+.BI "Option \*qSingleCard\*q \*q" boolean \*q
+As
+.BR IsolateDevice ,
+except that the bus ID of the first device in the layout is used.
+.PP
+Here is an example of a
+.B ServerLayout
+section for a dual headed configuration with two mice:
+.PP
+.RS 4
+.nf
+.B "Section \*qServerLayout\*q"
+.B " Identifier \*qLayout 1\*q"
+.B " Screen \*qMGA 1\*q"
+.B " Screen \*qMGA 2\*q RightOf \*qMGA 1\*q"
+.B " InputDevice \*qKeyboard 1\*q \*qCoreKeyboard\*q"
+.B " InputDevice \*qMouse 1\*q \*qCorePointer\*q"
+.B " InputDevice \*qMouse 2\*q \*qSendCoreEvents\*q"
+.B " Option \*qBlankTime\*q \*q5\*q"
+.B "EndSection"
+.fi
+.RE
+.SH "DRI SECTION"
+This optional section is used to provide some information for the
+Direct Rendering Infrastructure.
+Details about the format of this section can be found on-line at
+.IR <http://dri.freedesktop.org/> .
+.SH "VENDOR SECTION"
+The optional
+.B Vendor
+section may be used to provide vendor\-specific configuration information.
+Multiple
+.B Vendor
+sections may be present, and they may contain an
+.B Identifier
+entry and multiple
+.B Option
+flags.
+The data therein is not used in this release.
+.PP
+.SH "SEE ALSO"
+General:
+.BR X (__miscmansuffix__),
+.BR Xserver (__appmansuffix__),
+.BR __xservername__ (__appmansuffix__),
+.BR cvt (__appmansuffix__),
+.BR gtf (__appmansuffix__).
+.PP
+.B "Not all modules or interfaces are available on all platforms."
+.PP
+Display drivers:
+.BR apm (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR ati (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR chips (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR cirrus (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR cyrix (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR fbdev (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR glide (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR glint (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR i128 (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR i740 (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR imstt (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR intel (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR mga (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR neomagic (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR nv (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR openchrome (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR r128 (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR radeon (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR rendition (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR savage (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR s3virge (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR siliconmotion (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR sis (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR sisusb (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR sunbw2 (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR suncg14 (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR suncg3 (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR suncg6 (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR sunffb (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR sunleo (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR suntcx (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR tdfx (__drivermansuffix__),
+.\" .BR tga (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR trident (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR tseng (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR vesa (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR vmware (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR voodoo (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR wsfb (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR xgi (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR xgixp (__drivermansuffix__).
+.PP
+Input drivers:
+.BR acecad (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR citron (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR elographics (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR evdev (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR fpit (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR joystick (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR kbd (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR mousedrv (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR mutouch (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR penmount (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR synaptics (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR vmmouse (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR void (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR wacom (__drivermansuffix__).
+.PP
+Other modules and interfaces:
+.BR exa (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR fbdevhw (__drivermansuffix__),
+.\" .BR shadowfb (__drivermansuffix__),
+.BR v4l (__drivermansuffix__).
+.br
+.SH AUTHORS
+This manual page was largely rewritten by David Dawes
+.IR <dawes@xfree86.org> .
diff --git a/xorg-server/include/xkbsrv.h b/xorg-server/include/xkbsrv.h index 8257c54a6..9f7945e22 100644 --- a/xorg-server/include/xkbsrv.h +++ b/xorg-server/include/xkbsrv.h @@ -447,6 +447,11 @@ extern _X_EXPORT void XkbFreeKeyboard( Bool /* freeDesc */
);
+extern _X_EXPORT void XkbFreeComponentNames(
+ XkbComponentNamesPtr /* names */,
+ Bool /* freeNames */
+);
+
extern _X_EXPORT void XkbSetActionKeyMods(
XkbDescPtr /* xkb */,
XkbAction * /* act */,
diff --git a/xorg-server/xkb/XKBAlloc.c b/xorg-server/xkb/XKBAlloc.c index 8c439ba0b..89ba5fb4a 100644 --- a/xorg-server/xkb/XKBAlloc.c +++ b/xorg-server/xkb/XKBAlloc.c @@ -333,3 +333,22 @@ XkbFreeKeyboard(XkbDescPtr xkb,unsigned which,Bool freeAll) free(xkb);
return;
}
+
+
+/***====================================================================***/
+
+void
+XkbFreeComponentNames(XkbComponentNamesPtr names, Bool freeNames)
+{
+ if (names)
+ {
+ free(names->keycodes);
+ free(names->types);
+ free(names->compat);
+ free(names->symbols);
+ free(names->geometry);
+ memset(names, 0, sizeof(XkbComponentNamesRec));
+ }
+ if (freeNames)
+ free(names);
+}
diff --git a/xorg-server/xkb/ddxLoad.c b/xorg-server/xkb/ddxLoad.c index 8b3dab56d..13d2d6f1b 100644 --- a/xorg-server/xkb/ddxLoad.c +++ b/xorg-server/xkb/ddxLoad.c @@ -451,23 +451,23 @@ XkbRMLVOtoKcCGST(DeviceIntPtr dev, XkbRMLVOSet *rmlvo, XkbComponentNamesPtr kccg static XkbDescPtr
XkbCompileKeymapForDevice(DeviceIntPtr dev, XkbRMLVOSet *rmlvo, int need)
{
- XkbDescPtr xkb;
+ XkbDescPtr xkb = NULL;
unsigned int provided;
- XkbComponentNamesRec kccgst;
+ XkbComponentNamesRec kccgst = {0};
char name[PATH_MAX];
- if (!XkbRMLVOtoKcCGST(dev, rmlvo, &kccgst))
- return NULL;
-
- provided = XkbDDXLoadKeymapByNames(dev, &kccgst, XkmAllIndicesMask, need,
- &xkb, name, PATH_MAX);
- if ((need & provided) != need) {
- if (xkb) {
- XkbFreeKeyboard(xkb, 0, TRUE);
- xkb = NULL;
+ if (XkbRMLVOtoKcCGST(dev, rmlvo, &kccgst)) {
+ provided = XkbDDXLoadKeymapByNames(dev, &kccgst, XkmAllIndicesMask, need,
+ &xkb, name, PATH_MAX);
+ if ((need & provided) != need) {
+ if (xkb) {
+ XkbFreeKeyboard(xkb, 0, TRUE);
+ xkb = NULL;
+ }
}
}
+ XkbFreeComponentNames(&kccgst, FALSE);
return xkb;
}
diff --git a/xorg-server/xkb/xkb.c b/xorg-server/xkb/xkb.c index 9d6c4d4f6..136d3ac45 100644 --- a/xorg-server/xkb/xkb.c +++ b/xorg-server/xkb/xkb.c @@ -4307,10 +4307,21 @@ ProcXkbSetNames(ClientPtr client) #define XkbSizeCountedString(s) ((s)?((((2+strlen(s))+3)/4)*4):4)
+/**
+ * Write the zero-terminated string str into wire as a pascal string with a
+ * 16-bit length field prefixed before the actual string.
+ *
+ * @param wire The destination array, usually the wire struct
+ * @param str The source string as zero-terminated C string
+ * @param swap If TRUE, the length field is swapped.
+ *
+ * @return The input string in the format <string length><string> with a
+ * (swapped) 16 bit string length, non-zero terminated.
+ */
static char *
XkbWriteCountedString(char *wire,char *str,Bool swap)
{
- CARD16 len,*pLen;
+ CARD16 len,*pLen, paddedLen;
if (!str)
return wire;
@@ -4322,8 +4333,9 @@ XkbWriteCountedString(char *wire,char *str,Bool swap) register int n;
swaps(pLen,n);
}
- memcpy(&wire[2],str,len);
- wire+= ((2+len+3)/4)*4;
+ paddedLen= pad_to_int32(sizeof(len)+len)-sizeof(len);
+ strncpy(&wire[sizeof(len)],str,paddedLen);
+ wire+= sizeof(len)+paddedLen;
return wire;
}
@@ -4434,6 +4446,7 @@ xkbShapeWireDesc * shapeWire; if (shape->approx!=NULL)
shapeWire->approxNdx= XkbOutlineIndex(shape,shape->approx);
else shapeWire->approxNdx= XkbNoShape;
+ shapeWire->pad= 0;
if (swap) {
register int n;
swapl(&shapeWire->name,n);
@@ -4446,6 +4459,7 @@ xkbShapeWireDesc * shapeWire; olWire= (xkbOutlineWireDesc *)wire;
olWire->nPoints= ol->num_points;
olWire->cornerRadius= ol->corner_radius;
+ olWire->pad= 0;
wire= (char *)&olWire[1];
ptWire= (xkbPointWireDesc *)wire;
for (p=0,pt=ol->points;p<ol->num_points;p++,pt++) {
@@ -4559,6 +4573,8 @@ xkbOverlayWireDesc * olWire; olWire= (xkbOverlayWireDesc *)wire;
olWire->name= ol->name;
olWire->nRows= ol->num_rows;
+ olWire->pad1= 0;
+ olWire->pad2= 0;
if (swap) {
register int n;
swapl(&olWire->name,n);
@@ -4571,6 +4587,7 @@ xkbOverlayWireDesc * olWire; rowWire= (xkbOverlayRowWireDesc *)wire;
rowWire->rowUnder= row->row_under;
rowWire->nKeys= row->num_keys;
+ rowWire->pad1= 0;
wire= (char *)&rowWire[1];
for (k=0,key=row->keys;k<row->num_keys;k++,key++) {
xkbOverlayKeyWireDesc * keyWire;
@@ -5897,16 +5914,7 @@ ProcXkbGetKbdByName(ClientPtr client) XkbFreeKeyboard(new,XkbAllComponentsMask,TRUE);
new= NULL;
}
- free(names.keycodes);
- names.keycodes = NULL;
- free(names.types);
- names.types = NULL;
- free(names.compat);
- names.compat = NULL;
- free(names.symbols);
- names.symbols = NULL;
- free(names.geometry);
- names.geometry = NULL;
+ XkbFreeComponentNames(&names, FALSE);
return Success;
}
|